Upload
daniel-urzica
View
420
Download
3
Embed Size (px)
Citation preview
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
1
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
SWP 9400AWY R1.0 C.T. OPER.HDBK
TABLE OF CONTENTS
LIST OF FIGURES AND TABLES 7. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PRELIMINARY INFORMATION 11. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HANDBOOK APPLICABILITY, PURPOSE AND HISTORY 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HANDBOOK STRUCTURE 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SAFETY–EMC–ESD NORMS AND EQUIPMENT LABELLING 13. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
CAUTIONS TO AVOID EQUIPMENT DAMAGE 15. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
QUICK GUIDE 18. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SECTION 1: INSTALLATION 21. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1–1 SWP INSTALLATION IN PC ENVIRONMENT 23. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–1.1 Requirements 23. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1–1.1.1 PC characteristics 23. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–1.1.2 Operator skills 23. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1–1.2 Summary of SW installation phases 23. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–1.3 SWP loading in PC WINDOWS–NT/2000/XP environment 24. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1–1.3.1 Installation of 1320CT + NE software from SWP CD–ROM 24. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–1.3.2 Installation of SIBDL program from SWP CD–ROM 54. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–1.3.3 End of SW installation from SWP CD–ROM 54. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–1.3.4 De–installation phases 54. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1–1.4 CT initial configuration 56. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–1.4.1 Craft Terminal configuration 56. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–1.4.2 Craft Terminal connection to the NE 57. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1–2 SWP DOWNLOAD TOWARD NE 59. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–2.1 Requirements 59. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1–2.1.1 NE hardware 59. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–2.1.2 Craft Terminal 59. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–2.1.3 Operator skills and profile 59. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1–2.2 Summary of the SWP installation phases 60. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–2.3 SW download to the NE 60. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
ED DATE CHANGE NOTE APPRAISAL AUTHORITY ORIGINATOR
01 040519 A.FUMAGALLI ITAVE G.ZILIANI RTT
02 040723 S404070501 A.FUMAGALLI ITAVE G.ZILIANI RTT
04122203 S404102601 A.BESTETTI ITAVE G.ZILIANI RTT
9400AWY–FSO REL.1.0SWP VERSION UP TO V1.0.2OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK
G.CONSONNI E.CORRADINI – ITAVE
V.RODELLA E.CORRADINI–ITAVE
A.FUMAGALLI E.CORRADINI–C.NAVA
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
2
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–2.4 NE Login 72. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–2.5 Commissioning 73. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–2.6 Configuration data definition 73. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
1–3 NE UPGRADE TO A NEWER SWP ’VERSION’ (SAME SWP ’RELEASE’) 75. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SECTION 2: AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT 77. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–1 GENERAL INTRODUCTION ON VIEWS AND MENUS 79. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1.1 9400 AWY/FSO view organization 79. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–1.1.1 View Area 81. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1.1.2 Resource Tree Area 82. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1.1.3 Resource Detail Area 83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1.1.4 Button Policy 83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–1.2 Introduction to the menu options 84. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1.2.1 Views menu introduction 85. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1.2.2 Configuration menu introduction 87. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1.2.3 Diagnosis menu introduction 87. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1.2.4 Supervision menu introduction 88. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1.2.5 Download menu introduction 88. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–2 CONFIGURATION 89. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.1 NE Time 89. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.2 Network Configuration 90. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–2.2.1 Local Configuration 91. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.2.2 Ethernet Configuration 92. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.2.3 IP Configuration 93. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.2.4 Routing information 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–2.3 Alarm Severities 101. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.3.1 How to create a new Alarm Severity Profile 103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–2.4 System Settings 106. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.4.1 NE Configuration (V 1.0.0 and V 1.0.1) 106. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.4.2 NE Configuration (V 1.0.2) 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.4.3 Link Indentifier 111. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2.4.4 Overhead 112. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–2.5 Quick Configuration Procedure 113. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–3 EQUIPMENT 127. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–3.1 IDU level 130. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–3.1.1 1+0 configuration 130. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–3.1.2 “1+0 extendable” and “1+1” configuration 131. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–3.1.3 Procedure for configuration change from “1+0 extendable” to “1+1” 131. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–3.1.4 Board level 132. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–3.2 ODU level 133. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–3.3 Tab panels in the Resource Detail Aarea 134. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–3.3.1 Alarms 134. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–3.3.2 Configuration 135. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–3.3.3 Remote Inventory 135. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–4 LINE INTERFACE 137. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–4.1 Tab panels in the Resource Detail Area 138. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–4.1.1 Alarm 138. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–4.1.2 Configuration 138. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
3
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–5 RADIO 143. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.1 Alarm 144. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.2 Configuration 144. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–5.2.1 Local or Remote Transmitter Mute 144. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.2.2 ODU service kit 144. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.2.3 Alarm Profile 144. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–5.3 Frequency 145. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.3.1 Tx Radio Frequency 145. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.3.2 Rx Radio Frequency 145. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–5.4 RTPC & ATPC 146. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.4.1 ATPC 146. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.4.2 Tx Nominal Power 146. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.4.3 Tx Current Power 146. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.4.4 ATPC Range 147. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.4.5 ATPC Rx Threshold 147. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–5.5 Power Measurement 147. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–5.5.1 How to read a Power Measurement file 151. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–6 FSO 153. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–6.1 Channel#1 154. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–6.2 FSO Port#1 – Ch#1 155. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–6.2.1 Alarm 156. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–6.2.2 Configuration 156. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–6.2.3 Measurements 156. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–6.3 Laser#1 or Laser#2 161. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–7 EXTERNAL POINTS 163. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–7.1 Input External Points 163. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–7.2 Output External Points (in V.1.0.0) 164. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–7.3 Output External Points (in V.1.0.1 and V.1.0.2) 165. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–8 SUPERVISION 167. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–8.1 Access state (allow or inhibit NE Craft access) 167. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–8.1.1 Switching from the OS to the Craft Terminal access state 167. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–8.1.2 Switching from the Craft Terminal access state back to the OS access state 168. . . . . .
2–8.2 Restart NE 168. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–8.3 SW key 169. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–9 PROTECTION SCHEMES 171. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–9.1 Mux Protection Management 172. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–9.1.1 Schema Parameters 173. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–9.1.2 Commands 173. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–9.2 Radio Protection Management 175. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–9.2.1 Schema Parameter 176. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–9.2.2 Commands 176. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–9.3 HST Transmission Protection Management 178. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–9.3.1 Schema Parameters 178. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–9.3.2 Commands 179. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–10 LOOPBACKS 181. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–10.1 Available Loopbacks 182. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–10.1.1 1+0 FSO Loopbacks 183. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–10.1.2 1+0 Radio Loopbacks 186. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–10.1.3 1+1 Radio Loopbacks 189. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–10.2 How to activate a loopback 192. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
4
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–10.3 How to remove a loopback 193. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–11 DIAGNOSIS 195. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–11.1 Log Browsing 195. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–11.2 Remote Inventory 195. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–11.3 Abnormal Condition List 196. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–11.4 Summary Block Diagram View 196. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–11.5 Current Configuration View 200. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–12 PERFORMANCE MONITORING 201. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–12.1 General information on the performance monitoring process 201. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–12.2 Performance menu 203. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–12.3 CD (Current Data) 205. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–12.3.1 CD parameters 206. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–12.3.2 CD Counters 206. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–12.4 HD (History Data) 207. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–12.4.1 HD Parameters 207. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–12.5 Threshold Data 208. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2–13 SW DOWNLOAD 211. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–13.1 Server Access Configuration 211. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–13.2 Init SW Download 212. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–13.3 SW Status 213. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SECTION 3: AWY/FSO MAINTENANCE 215. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3–1 MAINTENANCE INTRODUCTION 216. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–1.1 Maintenance of the PC 216. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–1.2 Problems with THE Craft Terminal 216. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3–2 TROUBLESHOOTING 217. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2.1 Purpose of this procedure 217. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2.2 Corrective Maintenance general flow–chart 217. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2.3 Troubleshooting organization 218. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2.4 Troubleshooting by means of the Craft Terminal 220. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3–2.4.1 Alarm synthesis indication 221. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2.4.2 Details on alarms / statuses 222. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
3–2.5 Description of alarms and of probable causes 224. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SECTION 4: SWP DESCRIPTION AND VERSIONS 227. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4–1 SWP 9400AWY R.1.0 DESCRIPTION 229. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–1.1 General 229. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–1.2 Software product list and part numbers 229. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–1.3 Software licence list and part numbers 230. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4–2 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V1.0.0 SPECIFIC INFORMATION 231. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–2.1 ECT requirements 231. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–2.2 SWP version specific data 232. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4–2.2.1 SW Package Identification 232. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–2.2.2 SW Package Components 232. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–2.2.3 ECT SW Sub–Components 232. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–2.2.4 NE MIB Compatibility 232. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4–2.3 New features and modifications 233. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–2.4 Restrictions and known problems 233. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
5
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–2.5 New features and modifications of SWP versions higher than V.1.0.0 233. . . . . . . . . . . .
4–3 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V1.0.1 SPECIFIC INFORMATION 235. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–3.1 ECT requirements 235. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–3.2 SWP version specific data 236. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4–3.2.1 SW Package Identification 236. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–3.2.2 SW Package Components 236. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–3.2.3 ECT SW Sub–Components 236. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–3.2.4 NE MIB Compatibility 236. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4–3.3 New features and modifications 237. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–3.4 Restrictions and known problems 238. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–3.5 Operative hints 238. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–3.6 New features and modifications of SWP versions higher than V.1.0.1 238. . . . . . . . . . . .
4–4 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V1.0.2 SPECIFIC INFORMATION 239. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–4.1 ECT requirements 239. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–4.2 SWP version specific data 240. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4–4.2.1 SW Package Identification 240. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–4.2.2 SW Package Components 240. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–4.2.3 ECT SW Sub–Components 240. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–4.2.4 NE MIB Compatibility 240. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
4–4.3 New features and modifications 240. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
SECTION 5: APPENDICES 241. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
APPENDIX A : EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION AND COMPONENTS 243. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A.1 : Functions and configurations 244. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A.2 : IDU and ODU Components 245. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
A.2.1 : IDU 245. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A.2.2 : ODU 246. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A.2.3 : Allowed Equipment Types 247. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A.2.4 : Remote Inventory Management 249. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
APPENDIX B : SW ALLOCATION, FLASH CARD AND EQUIPMENT CONTROL 251. . . . . . . . . . . . B.1 : Allocation of equipment and craft terminal software 252. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B.2 : Flash Card 254. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
B.2.1 : Flash Card types 254. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B.2.2 : Flash Card identification 254. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B.2.3 : Flash Card contents 255. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B.2.4 : Flash Card upgrade (for 9400AWY only) 255. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
B.3 : Equipment control 256. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B.3.1 : Interfaces (see Fig. 157. on page 243): 256. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B.3.2 : Operator–Equipment Interaction 256. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B.3.3 : ECT 257. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B.3.4 : RECT 257. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
APPENDIX C : GENERAL ON SWP INSTALLATION 259. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C.1 : Troubleshooting situations 260. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C.2 : Common situations 261. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
APPENDIX D : ECT–EQUIPMENT CONNECTION VIA PUBLIC SWITCHED TELEPHONE NETWORK 263. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
D.1 : Introduction 263. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D.2 : Certified equipment 264. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D.3 : Connection cables 265. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
6
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
D.4 : Modem setting 266. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D.4.1 : Setting of Sportster Flash Modem & 3Com 56K Faxmodem 266. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D.4.2 : TD–32 AC Modem setting 268. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
D.5 : PC laptop “Dell Latitude” setting 269. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D.6 : Setting up the connection 270. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D.7 : Changing the ECT–equipment connection speed 271. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
D.7.1 : Introduction 271. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D.7.2 : Configuration at PC side 272. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
APPENDIX E : DOCUMENTATION GUIDE 273. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E.1 : Handbook guide 273. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
E.1.1 : Handbook applicability 274. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E.1.2 : Purpose of the handbook 275. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E.1.3 : Handbook history 276. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
E.2 : Documentation set description 279. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E.2.1 : 9400AWY Rel.1.0 product–release–version handbooks 280. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E.2.2 : 9400FSO Rel.1.0 product–release–version handbooks 282. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E.2.3 : Handbooks common to 9400AWY Rel.1.0 and 9400FSO Rel.1.0 284. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E.2.4 : Specific documentation for SNMP 285. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E.2.5 : General on Alcatel Customer Documentation 285. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
APPENDIX F : ACRONYMS AND ABBREVIATIONS 289. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
APPENDIX G : GLOSSARY OF TERMS 293. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
7
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
LIST OF FIGURES AND TABLES
FIGURESFig. 1. Windows NT installation step 1 29. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 2. Windows NT installation step 2 30. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 3. Windows NT installation step 3 30. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 4. Windows NT configuration step 1 31. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 5. Windows NT configuration step 2 32. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 6. Windows NT configuration step 3 32. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 7. Windows NT configuration step 4 33. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 8. Windows NT configuration step 5 34. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 9. Windows NT configuration step 6 34. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 10. Windows 2000 installation step 1 35. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 11. Windows 2000 installation step 2 36. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 12. Windows 2000 installation step 3 37. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 13. Windows 2000 installation step 4 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 14. Windows 2000 installation step 5 39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 15. Windows 2000 configuration step 1 40. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 16. Windows 2000 configuration step 2 41. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 17. Windows 2000 configuration step 3 42. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 18. Windows XP installation step 1 44. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 19. Windows XP installation step 2 45. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 20. Windows XP installation step 3 46. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 21. Windows XP installation step 4 47. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 22. Windows XP installation step 5 48. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 23. Windows XP configuration step 1 49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 24. Windows XP configuration step 2 50. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 25. Windows XP configuration step 3 51. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 26. Windows XP configuration step 4 52. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 27. De–installation 55. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 28. 9400 AWY Main view organization 80. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 29. View Areas 81. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 30. Resource tree area 82. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 31. Tab panels 86. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 32. NE Time dialogue box 89. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 33. Network Configuration menu 90. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 34. Local Configuration dialogue box 91. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 35. Ethernet Configuration dialogue box 92. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 36. IP configuration screen 93. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 37. IP static routing configuration screen 94. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 38. Create Static routing 95. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 39. Point To Point Interface Choice 96. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 40. OSPF Area configuration screen 97. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 41. Create New OSPF Area 98. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 42. IP Address configuration of Point–To–Point Interfaces screen 99. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 43. Routing information screen 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 44. Alarm Severities Profile 102. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 45. Name of a cloned alarm profile 103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 46. Clone of an Alarm Severity Profile 103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 47. Selection of a new severity in the Service Affecting field 104. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 48. Selection of a new severity in the No Service Affecting field 105. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 49. System Settings: NE configuration (V 1.0.0 and V 1.0.1) 106. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 50. System Settings: NE configuration (V 1.0.2) 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
8
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 51. Confirmation message 109. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 52. USM closing warning message 109. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 53. System Settings: Link Identifier 111. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 54. Overhead Configuration 112. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 55. Quick Installation Procedure: NE Configuration (Step 1) 114. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 56. Quick Installation Procedure: Frame Configuration (Step 2) 115. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 57. Quick Installation Procedure: Tributaries Configuration (Step 3) 116. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 58. Quick Installation Procedure: Tributaries Configuration (Step 4) 117. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 59. Quick Configuration Procedure: Channels Configuration (Step 5) 118. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 60. Quick Configuration Procedure: Local IP Address (Step 6) 119. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 61. Quich Installation Procedure: OSPF Area Configuration (Step 7) 120. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 62. Quick Installation Procedure: IP Static Router Configuration (Step 8) 121. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 63. Quick Configuration Procedure: NMS–RF Interface Configuration (Step 9) 122. . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 64. Quick Configuration Procedure: NMS–V11 Interface Configuration (Step 10) 123. . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 65. Quick Configuration Procedure: NMS–G703 Interface Configuration (Step 11) 124. . . . . . . . . Fig. 66. Quick Installation Procedure: Ethernet Configuration (Step 12) 125. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 67. Quick Configuration Procedure: Summary (Step 13) 126. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 68. 1+0 FSO Equipment view 127. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 69. 1+0 Radio Equipment view 128. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 70. 1+1 Radio Equipment view 128. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 71. 1+0 EXP Radio Equipment view 129. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 72. 1+0 IDU view 130. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 73. 1+1 IDU view 131. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 74. Main board view 132. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 75. FSO ODU view 133. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 76. Radio ODU view 133. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 77. Alarm tab panel for a selected object 134. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 78. Configuration tab panel for a selected object 135. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 79. Remote Inventory tab panel for a selected object 135. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 80. Line Interface View 137. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 81. Line Interface View: E1 Tributary Port 138. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 82. Line Interface View: E3 Tributary Port 138. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 83. Line Interface View: DS1 Tributary Port 141. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 84. Line Interface View: DS3 Tributary Port 141. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 85. Radio Domain View 143. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 86. Radio Frequency menu 145. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 87. Rtpc & Atpc 146. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 88. Power Measurements 147. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 89. Power Measurement Graphic 149. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 90. Power Meas Details 150. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 91. Name of File ( Log File ) selected screen 151. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 92. Example of “Power Measurement File Reading“ 151. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 93. Example of Power Measurement File Reading (with WordPad) 152. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 94. FSO Domain View 154. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 95. FSO port configuration 155. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 96. Measurements screen 156. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 97. Power Measurement Graphic Screen 157. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 98. Details Dialog screen 158. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 99. Name of File ( Log File ) selected screen 159. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 100. Example of “Power Measurement File Reading“ 159. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 101. Example of Power Measurement File Reading (with WordPad) 160. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 102. FSO laser configuration 161. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 103. Input External Point View 163. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 104. Output External Points View 164. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
9
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 105. Output External Points View 165. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 106. Configuration of the Craft access state from the Equipment NE view in the OS mode 167. . Fig. 107. Restart NE call 168. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 108. Restart NE confirmation 168. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 109. SW key screen 169. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 110. Protection Schemes 171. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 111. Mux Protection 172. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 112. Mux Protection Switch (Spare #0) 173. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 113. Mux Protection Switch (Main #1) 174. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 114. Radio Protection View 175. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 115. Radio Protection Switch (Spare #0) 176. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 116. Radio Protection Switch (Main #1) 177. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 117. Transmission Protection View 178. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 118. Tx Protection Commands (Spare #0) 179. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 119. Tx Protection Commands (Main #1) 180. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 120. 1+0 FSO available loopbacks 183. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 121. Channel 1 Loopback View 184. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 122. Tributaries Loopback View 184. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 123. 1+0 FSO Loopback types 185. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 124. 1+0 Radio available loopbacks 186. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 125. Channel 1 Loopback View 187. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 126. Tributaries Loopback View 187. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 127. 1+0 Radio Loopback types 188. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 128. 1+1 Radio available loopbacks 189. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 129. Channel 1 Loopback View 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 130. Tributaries Loopback View 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 131. 1+1 Radio Loopback types 191. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 132. Loopback activation 192. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 133. Loopback removing 193. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 134. Diagnosis menu 195. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 135. Summary Block Diagram View: 1+0 FSO 197. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 136. Summary Block Diagram View: 1+0 Radio 198. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 137. Summary Block Diagram View: 1+1 HST Radio 199. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 138. Summary Block Diagram View: 1+1 FD Radio 200. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 139. Radio section 201. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 140. Anomalies, defects, errored blocks, ES and SES according to ITU–T G.826 202. . . . . . . . . . Fig. 141. Performance View 203. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 142. Threshold table association screen 204. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 143. Current Data View 205. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 144. History Data 207. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 145. Thresholds Tables 208. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 146. Threshold table configuration 209. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 147. Server access configuration screen 211. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 148. Init Software Download screen 212. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 149. SW Status screen 213. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 150. SW Unit Status screen 214. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 151. Corrective Maintenance general flow–chart 217. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 152. Active alarm screem 222. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 153. (1+0) IDU 245. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 154. (1+1) and (1+0 expandable) IDU 245. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 155. (1+0) ODU (electrical or optical) 246. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 156. (1+1) ODU (only electrical) 246. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 157. Interfaces for equipment control and Flash card label on MAIN Unit 251. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 158. MAIN unit + FLASH CARD 251. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
10
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 159. FLASH CARD profile and insertion direction 251. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 160. Equipment main parts containing local SW 252. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 161. Software management main phases 259. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 162. ECT–Equipment connection via Public Switched Telephone Network 263. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 163. ECT–Local external Modem cable 265. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 164. F Interface–Remote Modem cable 265. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 165. TD–32 AC modem dip–switch setting 268. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 166. Alcatel Lower Layers utility 272. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 167. Example of SWP Release and Version numbering 286. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 168. Example of Product levels and associated Customer Documentation 287. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
TABLESTab. 1. Radio application: Market, capacity and modulation 107. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 2. FSO application: Market, capacity and modulation 107. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 3. Radio application: Market, capacity and modulation 110. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 4. FSO application: Market, capacity and modulation 110. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 5. Command priority list 174. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 6. Command priority list 177. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 7. Command priority list 180. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 8. Loopbacks on the local NE 182. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 9. 1+0 FSO loopbacks 183. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 10. 1+0 Radio loopbacks 186. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 11. 1+1 Radio loopbacks 189. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 12. SES Thresholds 201. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 13. Alarm Synthesis indication 221. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 14. Alarm information, general description 223. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 15. General issues of the alarm meanings and their respective maintenance actions 225. . . . . . . Tab. 16. Software products part numbers 229. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 17. Software licence part numbers 230. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 18. Markets, product type, tributaries and modulations forecasted 244. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 19. Shelves Equipment Types 247. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 20. IDU allowed board/plug–in types in (1+0) configurations 248. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 21. IDU allowed board/plug–in types in (1+1) and (1+0 expandable) configurations 248. . . . . . . . Tab. 22. Allowed board types in optical ODU ETSI 249. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 23. Available Flash cards 254. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 24. Handbook history 276. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 25. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 product release handbooks 280. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 26. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Technical Handbook 281. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 27. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Installation and Line–Up Handbooks 281. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 28. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Documentation on CD–ROM 281. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 29. 9400FSO Rel.1.0 product release handbooks 282. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 30. 9400FSO Rel.1.0 Technical Handbook 283. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 31. 9400FSO Rel.1.0 Installation and Line–Up Handbooks 283. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 32. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Documentation on CD–ROM 283. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 33. Operator’s Handbooks related to the specific Software Package SWP 284. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tab. 34. Documentation common to Alcatel Network Elements using 1320CT platform 284. . . . . . . . .
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
11
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
PRELIMINARY INFORMATION
a ) Warranty
Any warranty must be referred exclusively to the terms of the contact of sale of the equipment thishandbook refers to.ALCATEL makes no warranty of any kind with regards to this manual, and specifically disclaims theimplied warranties of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose. ALCATEL will not be liablefor errors contained herein or for damages, whether direct, indirect, consequential, incidental, orspecial, in connection with the furnishing, performance, or use of this material.
b ) Information
The product specification and/or performance levels contained in this document are for informationpurposes only and are subject to change without notice. They do not represent any obligation on thepart of ALCATEL.
c ) Copyright Notification
The technical information of this manual is the property of ALCATEL and must not be copied,reproduced or disclosed to a third party without written consent.
d ) Safety recommendations
The safety recommendations here below must be considered to avoid injuries on persons and/ordamage to the equipment:
1 ) Service PersonnelInstallation and service must be carried out by authorized people having appropriate technicaltraining and experience necessary to be aware of hazardous operations during installation andservice and of measures to avoid any danger to them, to any other people and to the equipment.
2 ) Access to the EquipmentAccess to the Equipment in use must be restricted to Service Personnel only.
3 ) Safety normsRecommended safety norms are not indicated in this manual, but in Handbooks REF. [A] onpage 281 and [E] on page 283. The warning labels that can be found on the equipment partsare indicated on page 13.Local safety regulations must be used if mandatory. Safety instructions in such handbookshould be used in addition to the local safety regulations. In the case of conflict between safetyinstructions stated in such manual and those indicated in local regulations, mandatory localnorms will prevail. Should not local regulations be mandatory, then safety norms in the abovecited manual will prevail.
e ) Service Personnel skillService Personnel must have been an adequate technical training on telecommunications and inparticular on the equipment this handbook refers to.Reading this handbook and the associated handbooks indicated in para.E.2 on page 279 is usuallynot enough to properly install, operate and maintain equipment.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
12
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
HANDBOOK APPLICABILITY, PURPOSE AND HISTORY
Please refer to para.E.1 on page 273.
HANDBOOK STRUCTURE
Information in this handbook is divided into the following parts:
a ) FRONT MATTER• TABLE OF CONTENTS• LIST OF FIGURES AND TABLES• PRELIMINARY INFORMATION• HANDBOOK STRUCTURE• SAFETY–EMC–ESD NORMS AND EQUIPMENT LABELLING• CAUTIONS TO AVOID EQUIPMENT DAMAGE• QUICK GUIDE
It allows to access immediately the most frequently needed operative pieces of informationcontained in this handbook and in other related handbooks.
b ) SECTION 1: INSTALLATION on page 21This part describes in detail the operations necessary for the SWP installation and upgrading (ECTparts and equipment parts).
c ) SECTION 2: AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT on page 77In this section, the description of the menu structure and of all the AWY and FSO NE functionalitiesavailable in the Craft Terminal is given.
d ) SECTION 3: AWY/FSO NE MAINTENANCE on page 215In this section the description of the AWY and FSO NE troubleshooting based on the use of the CraftTerminal is given.
e ) SECTION 4: SWP DESCRIPTION AND VERSIONS on page 227This section gives information on the Software Packages this handbook refers to, and that are bothindependent and independent on the specific SWP Version: commercial information (SWP andSoftware Licences P/Ns), PC requirements, SW Package Identification, SW Package Components,ECT SW Sub–Component, NE MIB Compatibility and additional features of new SWP versions.
f ) SECTION 5: APPENDICES on page 241In this section some additional information and instructions are given:• Equipment description and components• SW allocation, Flash Card and equipment control• General on SWP installation• ECT–Equipment connection via public switched telephone network• Documentation Guide• Acronyms and abbreviations• Glossary of terms
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
13
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
SAFETY–EMC–ESD NORMS AND EQUIPMENT LABELLING
a ) Please refer to Technical Handbook to obtain details regarding following information:
• Compliance with European norms
• Safety rules:
TOPIC WARNING LABEL ON EQUIPMENT
General rules
Dangerous Electrical Voltages
Harmful optical signals
For 9400FSO read carefully next page
Risk of explosion
Moving mechanical parts
Heat–radiating mechanical parts
Equipment emitting RF power
• Equipment protection against electrostatic discharges:
TOPIC WARNING LABEL ON EQUIPMENT
Device sensitive to electrostatic discharges
• Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC norms)
• Other Labels affixed to the Equipment
b ) Identical or similar information on Personal Computer, Work–Station etc., other than ALCATEL’s,loaded with software applications described in this Handbook, is supplied in the Constructor’stechnical documentation.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
14
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
WARNING FOR 9400FSO ODU EQUIPMENT!
CAUTION: USE OF CONTROL OR ADJUSTMENTS OR PERFORMANCE OF PROCEDURES OTHERTHAN THOSE SPECIFIED HEREIN MAY RESULT IN HAZARDOUS LASER RADIATION EXPOSURE!
Product Laser SafetyThe following special notes provide the laser safety specifications for the 9400FSO Terminal:
INFORMATION ALERT!
LASER DEVICES PRESENT WITHIN THIS EQUIPMENT ARE HAZARDOUS WHEN VIEWED WITHOPTICAL INSTRUMENTS.LASER HAS THE FOLLOWING OUTPUT CHARACTERISTICS UNDER MAXIMUM CONDITIONS:
Laser Type Wavelength (nm) Output Power (mW)–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––VCSEL 835 – 865 16–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
EN –CLASS 1M laser products According to EN 60825–1 ; EN 60825–2
INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION
DO NOT VIEW DIRECTLY WITH OPTICAL INSTRUMENTS (BINOCULARS OR TELESCOPES)
CLASS 1M LASER PRODUCT
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
15
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
CAUTIONS TO AVOID EQUIPMENT DAMAGE
a ) Antistatic protection device kit
When operating on boards out of the equipment shelf, this kit (see figure below) must be always warnand its termination must be connected to a grounded structure, to avoids the possible damage of theelectronic devices for electrostatic discharges.
ELASTICIZED BAND
COILED CORD
b ) Board’s extraction/insertion levers on ACCESS, MAIN IDU and EXTENSION IDU units
These units are provided with levers to facilitate their extraction and insertion from/into the shelf. Inturn, such levers are provided with screws that:• must be loosened, before operating on levers for the unit extraction from the shelf; this avoids
the breakage of levers• must be tightened, after the unit insertion in the shelf; this ensures the equipment EMI–EMC
performance.Please refer to page 17 for more information [ points h ) , i ) and j ) ].
c ) Unit assemblies
Each of the ACCESS, MAIN IDU, EXTENSION IDU and FANS unit assembly (“main board” + “babyboard(s)” + “front plate”) must be considered an unique item from the service and maintenance pointsof view. Such an assembly is supplied by Alcatel “as it is” and must never be disassembled.
d ) Screw fixing
All boards and dummy plates are provided with screws that, in normal operation conditions, must bealways tightened onto the shelf to avoid their detachment and to ensure the equipment EMI–EMCperformance and correct ventilation.The screw tightening torque for fixing the units to the subrack must be:
2.8 kg x cm (0.28 Newton x m) � 10 %
2.4317 in lb (0.2026 ft lb) � 10 %
Exceeding this value may result in screw breaking.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
16
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
e ) IDU–ODU cable disconnection / connection
Before to disconnect or connect the IDU–ODU cable (at IDU or ODU side) switch off thecorresponding MAIN IDU UNIT or EXTENSION IDU UNIT.
f ) Craft Terminal connection
To connect the CT cable (at IDU’s F interface and/or PC side):• verify that the PC is switched off (if switched on, close all running applications, then switch off
it)• connect suitable cable to IDU’s F interface and PC side• now the PC can be safely switched on.
g ) Craft Terminal disconnection
To disconnect the CT cable (at IDU’s F interface and/or PC side):• perform the logoff, exiting from the CT applications• close all other running applications, if any• switch off the PC• now the cable can be safely disconnected.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
17
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
h ) Right operations for board insertion in the subrack
1) Open the levers before to plug the unit. 2) To mate the plastic body of the connectors:push on the front panel, balancing the strainwithout push on the levers.
3) Push on the levers in order to finishthe connector mating.
4) Fix the unit to the subrack by meansof screws (max tightening torquespecified in point d ) on page 15
i ) Forbidden operations for board insertion in the subrack
NO Don’t push just on one lever only.
NO Don’t force the units.
NO Avoid impact during the units handling.
j ) To populate an empty subrack1 ) insert one unit at a time2 ) fix the unit to the subrack by means of screws, before to insert another unit.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
18
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
QUICK GUIDEC.T. OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK SWP 9400AWY R.1.0
If you need immediate operative information on how to:
GENERAL TOPICS FOR 9400AWY AND 9400FSO
get information on systemdocumentation
read Appendix E on page 273
get information on safety, EMC,ESD norms and equipment labelling
read page 13
have the description of the systemfrom the software point of view
read:
Chapter 4–1 on page 229
Appendix A on page 243
Appendix B on page 251
logically configure a station (orchange its configuration) andlogically set–up connections
get:
9400AWY T h i l H db k (R f [A] 281)logically provision equipment boards
9400AWY Technical Handbook (Ref. [A] on page 281)
get item P/Nsor
SO fget operative information regardingthe units in IDU shelf and ODU(connectors, leds, buttons)
9400FSO Technical Handbook (Ref. [E] on page 283)
and read its QUICK GUIDE (same topics)
HW INSTALLATION
physically install and cable theequipment hardware
For:
– 9400AWY, get 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Installation Handbook(Ref.[B] on page 281) and proceed as specified by it
– 9400FSO, get 9400FSO Rel.1.0 Installation Handbook(Ref.[F] on page 283) and proceed as specified by it
continues ..
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
19
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
.. continuesIf you need immediate operative information on how to:
SWP INSTALLATION AND COMMISSIONING
install SWP (first time) on ECT proceed as specified in chapter 1–1 on page 23
download SWP (first time) into theequipment
proceed as specified in chapter 1–2 on page 59
commission equipment
For:
– 9400AWY, get 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Line–up Guide(Ref.[C] on page 281) and proceed as specified by it
– 9400FSO, get 9400FSO Rel.1.0 Line–up Guide(REF.[G] on page 283) and proceed as specified by it
update ECT and equipment with anewer SWP version (same SWPrelease)
proceed as specified in chapter 1–3 on page 75
ECT SOFTWARE USAGE FOR EQUIPMENT SW MANAGEMENT
have an overview on menu treestructure
manage equipment configuration
set–up parameters for maintenance(configure housekeeping alarms;configure the Alarms Management,access the Alarm Surveillance andshow the alarm condition).
open SECTION 2 – AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT on page77 of this handbook and then search the informationaccording to the listed topics
access the Events Log file
use of the Performance Monitoringfunctionalities
continues ..
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
20
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
.. continuesIf you need immediate operative information on how to:
9400AWY MAINTENANCE
provision and manage spare partsget 9400AWY Technical Handbook (Ref. [A] on page 281)
carry out preventive maintenance
get 9400AWY Technical Handbook (Ref. [A] on page 281)and read its QUICK GUIDE (same topic)
carry out corrective maintenance
get 9400AWY Technical Handbook (Ref. [A] on page 281),and go to its section MAINTENANCE, chapter Second LevelMaintenance paragraph Corrective Maintenance andproceed as specified; in any case, such section will usuallylead to the SECTION 3 – AWY/FSO NE MAINTENANCE onpage 215 of this handbook.
Alternatively, access directly SECTION 3 – AWY/FSO NEMAINTENANCE on page 215 of this handbook and proceedas specified; if a board must be replaced, you will be led to theuse of paragraph Unit Replacement Procedures of the9400AWY Technical Handbook for the correct replacingprocedures.
9400FSO MAINTENANCE
provision and manage spare partsget 9400FSO Technical Handbook (Ref.[E] on page 283)
carry out preventive maintenance
get 9400FSO Technical Handbook (Ref.[E] on page 283)and read its QUICK GUIDE (same topic)
carry out corrective maintenance
get 9400FSO Technical Handbook (Ref.[E] on page 283),and go to its section MAINTENANCE, chapter Second LevelMaintenance paragraph Corrective Maintenance andproceed as specified; in any case, such section will usuallylead to the SECTION 3 – AWY/FSO NE MAINTENANCE onpage 215 of this handbook.
Alternatively, access directly SECTION 3 – AWY/FSO NEMAINTENANCE on page 215 of this handbook and proceedas specified; if a board must be replaced, you will be led to theuse of paragraph Unit Replacement Procedures of the9400FSO Technical Handbook for the correct replacingprocedures.
To find any other kind of information not listed in the above table, please refer to the TABLE OFCONTENTS of this handbook.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
21
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
SECTION 1: INSTALLATION
SECTION CONTENT PAGE
Chapter 1–1 – SWP installation in PC environmentThis chapter details all phases necessary to install for the first time a SWP in the PCenvironment or to upgrade it with a new version of the same SWP.
23
Chapter 1–2 – SWP download toward NEThis chapter details all phases necessary to install for the first time a SWP in theequipment environment.
59
Chapter 1–3 – NE Upgrade to a newer SWP ’version’ (same SWP ’release’)This chapter details all phases necessary to install a new SWP ’version’ in the PCenvironment as well as in the equipment environment.
75
The symbol points out references to Other Handbooks.
Referenced handbook P/Ns are given in para.E.2 on page 279.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
22
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
23
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1 SWP INSTALLATION IN PC ENVIRONMENT
This chapter details all phases necessary to install for the first time a SWP in the PC environment or toupgrade it with a new version of the same SWP.
Before starting the installation procedures, it is suggested to give a look to para.B.1 on page 252and Appendix C on page 259.
Procedures described in this chapter are carried out with the PC disconnected from the NE.
1–1.1 Requirements
1–1.1.1 PC characteristics
For version refer to paragraph on page
V 1.0.0, V 1.0.1 & V 1.0.2 4–2.1 231
1–1.1.2 Operator skills
The operator shall be familiar with the use of personal computers in WINDOWS–NT / WINDOWS 2000 / WINDOWS XP environment, internally to which the Network Element’s application software operates.
Furthermore, for a number of configuration applications, the operator shall be aware of somespecifications of the International Standard Organization (ISO) and of the standards applied to thePlesiochronous Digital Hierarchy (PDH) (ITU–T Recommandations).
1–1.2 Summary of SW installation phases
The sequence of installation phases for the SWP loading in PC WINDOWS–NT/XP/2000 environment (PCis disconnected from Equipment Controller) are as follows:
a ) Installation from SWP CD–ROM
1 ) installation of 1320CT + NE software from SWP CD–ROM2 ) installation of SIBDL program from SWP CD–ROM3 ) end of SW installation from SWP CD–ROM
b ) CT initial configuration
that are described in detail in following paragraphs.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
24
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3 SWP loading in PC WINDOWS–NT/2000/XP environment
Procedures described in the following are carried out with the PC disconnected from the NE.
1–1.3.1 Installation of 1320CT + NE software from SWP CD–ROM
This operation must be perfoms at Administrator of the PC, because it subsequently could be toset IP address .
Hereafter are described the SWP installation procedures to be used for:
– First installation
The first time this SWP is installed on the PC, follow this procedure:
1 ) First install the Java and LLMan components by using the guided installation mode, describedin the para. 1–1.3.1.1 – CT Products installation guided.
2 ) Second configure the Alcatel Virtual Network Card by using the procedure described in the para.1–1.3.1.2 – Alcatel Virtual Network Card configuration.
3 ) At the end install the other components, by using the automatic installation mode, described inthe para. 1–1.3.1.3 – CT Products automatic installation.
– Complete updating
To update one or more components on the PC, follow this procedure:
1 ) To update the Java and LLMan components use the guided installation mode, described in thepara. 1–1.3.1.1 – CT Products installation guided.
2 ) To update the other components use the automatic installation mode, described in the para.1–1.3.1.3 – CT Products automatic installation.
– Partial automatic updating
To update one or more components, excluded Java and LLMan, use only the automatic installationmode, described in the para. 1–1.3.1.3 – CT Products automatic installation.
WARNING: During the installation an ALCATEL directory is automatically created, if not alreadypresent.If ALCATEL directory is already present on the PC, for a correct operation of the FTPserver, this directory must have all upper case characters (i.e. “ALCATEL”).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
25
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3.1.1 CT Products installation guided
In the following is described (step by step) the procedure to install “JRE” and “Alcatel Lower LayerManager” with the “CT Products installation guided”.
Operations sequence:
Step 1. Select the “CT Products installation guided” and press “NEXT” button.
Step 2. Select “JRE” (ONLY if you have an OLDER version) and “Alcatel Lower Layer Manager”components.
WARNING: if try to update JRE and JRE V 1.4.1 is already installed, the procedure automaticallyde–install, it WITHOUT making the new installation. Keep attention in this case to the“Question Window” that appears, which ask you to proceed to the de–installation.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
26
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 3. Press “NEXT” button to execute the installation of the previously selected components.
Step 4. Press “NEXT” button to start the installation of the Lower Layers Manager.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
27
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 5. Select “Configure Lower Layer” and press “FINISH” button to complete the operation.
Step 6. Complete the configuration and press OK button.
N.B. If a network adapter is not running in the PC, you can set the “System identifier”field with asequence of 12 “0”. The following window will be displayed.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
28
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 9. Press YES button to confirm.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
29
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3.1.2 Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers
At first SWP installation on ECT, after installation of Alcatel Lower Layer Manager and before theinstallation of other ECT SW components, it is necessary, for NE connection using TCP/IP through serialport, to configure a Virtual Network Card.Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers is a software component used by Alcatel Lower LayersManager to manage TCP/IP packets through the serial port.Follow this guide to install and configure Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers using theControl Panel.Refer to para. 1–1.3.1.2.1 on page 29 for intallation on Windows NT 4.0; refer to para. 1–1.3.1.2.2 on page35 for intallation on Windows 2000; refer to para. 1–1.3.1.2.3 on page 43 for intallation on Windows XP.
1–1.3.1.2.1 Windows NT 4.0
1–1.3.1.2.1.1 Installing the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers
To install the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers select the Adapters tab in the Network ControlPanel applet.After installing Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers you need to configure it following theinstruction of the Windows NT 4.0: Configuring Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers section.Before installing Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers you need to install TCP/IP protocol (pleaserefer to Windows NT Help).– Click the Add... button in the Adapter tab of the Network Control Panel applet.
Fig. 1. Windows NT installation step 1
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
30
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– In the Insert Disk dialog box, type the source path of the driver files copied during installation phase(e.g. C:\WinNT\System32\Drivers\LLmanNIC; type ”echo %systemroot%” from a Command Promptwindow to discover the right location of the WinNT folder) and click OK.
Fig. 2. Windows NT installation step 2
– If the dialog box in Fig. 3. appears, the driver is already installed.
Fig. 3. Windows NT installation step 3
Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers is now installed. You need to configure its TCP/IPparameters before use it in with Alcatel Lower Layers Manager.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
31
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3.1.2.1.2 Configuring the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers
To configure the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers use both the Bindings and the Protocolstabs in the Network Control Panel applet.
Before configuring Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers you need to install TCP/IP protocol(please refer to Windows NT Help).
This operation must be perfoms at Administrator of the PC, because it subsequently could be toset IP address .
To install the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers run the Network Control Panel applet fromthe Control Panel.
– Select the bindings of Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers in the Bindings tab (1), (2) ofthe Network Control Panel applet.
– Disable any unneeded component (3), (4).
– Selecting the Protocols tab (5) of the Network Control Panel applet, the either a message box(Fig. 5. NT configuration step 2) or a dialog box (Fig. 6. NT configuration step 3) may appear.
– Follow the instrucions until the dialog box (Fig. 7. NT configuration step 4) will appear.
1
2
3
4
5
Fig. 4. Windows NT configuration step 1
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
32
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Click Yes to save changes.
Fig. 5. Windows NT configuration step 2
– Select Protocols tab (1), TCP/IP Protocol (2) and click the Properties button (3).
1
2
3
Fig. 6. Windows NT configuration step 3
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
33
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Configure the IP Address and the Subnet Mask for the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for LowerLayers and push OK.
1
2
3
4
5
Fig. 7. Windows NT configuration step 4
*** WARNING ***
If the IP Address of the Virtual Network Card has been changed after a complete SWP installation, it isnecessary, for a correct ECT functionality, to perform an explicit ECT re–customization by executing thefollowing command:
– Start → Programs → Alcatel → SNMPCT–K–ADD–ON v... → SNMP Add–On Customization
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
34
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Click Close in the Protocols tab of the Network Control Panel applet.
Fig. 8. Windows NT configuration step 5
– The new configuration of Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers will be used at the next restartof the computer.
– If you are configuring or installing the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers you can click Yes.If you are installing some other component you should click No and restart the computer later.
Fig. 9. Windows NT configuration step 6
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
35
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3.1.2.2 Windows 2000
1–1.3.1.2.2.1 Installing the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers
To install the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers run the Add/Remove Hardware Wizard fromthe Control Panel.Before installing and configuring Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers you need to install TCP/IPprotocol (please refer to Windows 2000 Help).Please make sure of Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers is not already installed on your PC:Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers has to be installed only once.After installing Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers you need to configure it following theinstruction of the Windows 2000: Configuring Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers section.
– Click the Next button in the Welcome to the Add/Remove Hardware Wizard dialog box.
Fig. 10. Windows 2000 installation step 1
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
36
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 11. Windows 2000 installation step 2
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
37
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Click the Have Disk... button in the Select Network Adapter dialog box.
Fig. 12. Windows 2000 installation step 3
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
38
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– In the Install From Disk dialog box, type the source path of the driver files copied during installationphase (e.g. C:\WinNT\System32\Drivers\LLmanNIC; type ”echo %systemroot%” from a CommandPropt window to discover the right location of the WinNT folder) and click OK.
Fig. 13. Windows 2000 installation step 4
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
39
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Click Next in the Start Hardware Installation dialog box.
Fig. 14. Windows 2000 installation step 5
Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers is now installed. You need to configure its TCP/IPparameters before use it in with Alcatel Lower Layers Manager.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
40
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3.1.2.2.2 Configuring the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers
This operation must be perfoms at Administrator of the PC, because it subsequently could be toset IP address .
To configure the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers run the Network and Dial–up connectionsapplet from the Control Panel.
Before installing and configuring Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers you need to install TCP/IPprotocol (please refer to Windows 2000 Help).
To install the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers run the Add/Remove Hardware Wizard fromthe Control Panel.
– Open the network connection using the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers from theNetwork and Dial–up connections applet.
Fig. 15. Windows 2000 configuration step 1
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
41
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Uncheck any unneeded component in the Properties dialog box General tab (1). Check and selectthe Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) component (2) and click Properties (3).
1
2
3
Fig. 16. Windows 2000 configuration step 2
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
42
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Configure the IP Address (1) and the Subnet Mask (2) and push OK (3).
3
1
2
Fig. 17. Windows 2000 configuration step 3
Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers is now configured. You need Alcatel Lower Layers Managerto use it.
*** WARNING ***
If the IP Address of the Virtual Network Card has been changed after a complete SWP installation, it isnecessary, for a correct ECT functionality, to perform an explicit ECT re–customization by executing thefollowing command:
– Start → Programs → Alcatel → SNMPCT–K–ADD–ON v... → SNMP Add–On Customization
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
43
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3.1.2.3 Windows XP
1–1.3.1.2.3.1 Installing the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers
To install the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers run the Add Hardware Wizard from the ControlPanel.
After installing Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers you need to configure it following theinstruction of the Windows XP: Configuring Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers section.
Please make sure of Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers is not already installed on your PC:Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers has to be installed only once.
– Click the Next button in the Welcome to the Add/Remove Hardware Wizard dialog box.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
44
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 18. Windows XP installation step 1
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
45
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 19. Windows XP installation step 2
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
46
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Click the Have Disk... button in the Select Network Adapter dialog box.
Fig. 20. Windows XP installation step 3
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
47
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– In the Install From Disk dialog box, type the source path of the driver files copied during installationphase (e.g. C:\WinNT\System32\Drivers\LLmanNIC; type ”echo %systemroot%” from a CommandPropt window to discover the right location of the WinNT folder) and click OK.
Fig. 21. Windows XP installation step 4
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
48
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Click Next in the The wizard is ready to install your hardware dialog box.
Fig. 22. Windows XP installation step 5
Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers is now installed. You need to configure its TCP/IPparameters before use it in with Alcatel Lower Layers Manager.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
49
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3.1.2.3.2 Configuring the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers
This operation must be perfoms at Administrator of the PC, because it subsequently could be toset IP address .
To configure the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers run the Network connections applet fromthe Control Panel.
To install the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers run the Add/Remove Hardware Wizard fromthe Control Panel.
– Open the network connection using the Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers from theNetwork and Dial–up connections applet.
Fig. 23. Windows XP configuration step 1
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
50
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Uncheck any unneeded component (disable always the QoS Packet Scheduler – 1 –) in theProperties dialog box General tab. Check and select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) component (2)and click Properties (3).
12
3
Fig. 24. Windows XP configuration step 2
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
51
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Configure the IP Address (1) and the Subnet Mask (2) and Advanced option (3) and then push OK(4).
4
1
2
3
Fig. 25. Windows XP configuration step 3
*** WARNING ***
If the IP Address of the Virtual Network Card has been changed after a complete SWP installation, it isnecessary, for a correct ECT functionality, to perform an explicit ECT re–customization by executing thefollowing command:
– Start → Programs → Alcatel → SNMPCT–K–ADD–ON v... → SNMP Add–On Customization
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
52
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– Configure the Advanced TCP/IP Settings dialog box select the WINS sheet (1), Disable NetBIOSover TCP/IP (2) and then push OK (3).
1
2
3
Fig. 26. Windows XP configuration step 4
Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers is now configured. You need Alcatel Lower LayersManager to use it.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
53
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3.1.3 CT Products installation guided
Hereafter is described the procedure to install all the components except “JRE” and “Alcatel Lower LayerManager” with the “CT Products automatic installation”
Operations sequence:
Step 1. Select the “CT Products automatic installation ” and press “NEXT” button.
Step 2. Select all components except “JRE” and “Alcatel Lower Layer Manager”.
Step 3. Press “NEXT” button to execute the installation of the previously selected components.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
54
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.3.2 Installation of SIBDL program from SWP CD–ROM
Refer to chapter B.1 for general information on SIBDL program (in particular point 2 ) in para.B.3.2 onpage 257 and point 2 ) in para.C.1 on page 260).
The SIBDL program is not automatically installed by the auto–installation process.
The installation of SIBDL is detailed in the dedicated Section of the:
9400AWY Line Up Guide
or
9400FSO Line Up Guide
N.B. It is not mandatory to install SIBDL in this phase. You can postpone it when necessary (take intoaccount that you will need the SWP CD–ROM).
1–1.3.3 End of SW installation from SWP CD–ROM
Having reached this phase, you have finished the Software transfer from SWP CD–ROM to the PCenvironment. Now, you can extract the SWP CD–ROM from the PC’s CD–ROM unit.
1–1.3.4 De–installation phases
This paragraph describes how de–install from the PC the Software Package required by the Craft Terminalto manage the relevant Network Element.
This can be useful, for example, when a version of the software package is no more updated.
To de–install the following procedure can be followed:
– with the CD–ROM containing the relevant Software product.
– with the Control Panel of WINDOWS NT or WINDOWS 2000/XP when the CD–ROM containing therelevant Software product is not present.
From Control Panel select Add/Remove Programmes and de–install the components shown in thefollowing figure.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
55
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 27. De–installation
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
56
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.4 CT initial configuration
Procedures described in the following are carried out with the PC disconnected from the NE.
1–1.4.1 Craft Terminal configuration
This procedure is necessary to configure the PC in order to manage the Network Elements and includesthe following types of configuration:
– PC hostname
– CT configuration
– Communication Protocol (TCP/IP):
• TCP/IP without a network card
• TCP/IP with a network card
• Switching between the two configurations
– Serial Communication with the NE
– Screen settings
In order to set–up these configurations, refer to:
1320CT Basic Craft Terminal Operator’s Handbook ,section “INSTALLATION”, chapter “Craft Terminal Configuration”
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
57
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–1.4.2 Craft Terminal connection to the NE
The CT can be connected to the NE through the Serial Port or through the Ethernet Network Port.
Only one connection can be active. The default connection is the Serial port.
1–1.4.2.1 Connection through the Serial Port
This connection is the default connection.
To connect the CT to the NE through the Serial Port:
1 ) The Alcatel Virtual Network Card for Lower Layers Software has to be installed on the PC (referto para. 1–1.3.1.2 on page 29).
N.B. If the IP Address configured for the Alcatel Virtual Card has been changed after the 1320CTPlatform installation, it is necessary to perform a re–customization by entering the followingcommand:
Start → Programs → Alcatel → SNMPCT–K–ADD–ON v.3.1.x → SNMP Add–On Customization
N.B. If the connection through Ethernet Network Port has been activated, to activate again theconnection through the Serial Port enter the following command:
Start → Programs → Alcatel → SNMPCT–K–ADD–ON v.3.1.x → NE Connection → Serial Port
1–1.4.2.2 Connection through the Ethernet Network Port
1 ) Configure the Network Card on the CT as explained in the 1320CT Basic Craft TerminalOperator’s Handbook.
2 ) Enter the NE and enable the Ethernet port on the NE (refer to para. 2–2.2.2 on page 92).
3 ) Quit the NE and close the Network Element Synthesis application.
4 ) Activate the CT Connection through the Ethernet Port by the following command:
Start→Programs→Alcatel→SNMPCT–K–ADD–ON v.3.1.x→NE Connection→Ethernet Port
N.B. If the IP Address configured on the Ethernet port has been changed, it is necessary to performa re–customization by entering the following commands:
Start → Programs → Alcatel → CT–K– v.3.1.x → Customization
Start → Programs → Alcatel → SNMPCT–K–ADD–ON v.3.1.x → NE Connection→Ethernet Port
Start → Programs → Alcatel → SNMPCT–K–ADD–ON v.3.1.x → SNMP Add–On Customization
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
58
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
59
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–2 SWP DOWNLOAD TOWARD NE
This chapter details all phases necessary to install for the first time a SWP in the equipment environment.
Before starting the installation procedures, it is suggested to give a look to para.B.1 on page 252and Appendix C on page 259.
Procedures described in this chapter are carried out with the PC connected to the NE.
1–2.1 Requirements
1–2.1.1 NE hardware
The equipment must have been already physically installed, cabled and powered on, according to theinstructions given in the:
9400AWY Installation Handbookor
9400FSO Installation Handbook
1–2.1.2 Craft Terminal
The Craft Terminal, already loaded with the SWP to be downloaded toward the NE (N.B.), must beavailable together with the cable for its connection to the equipment F interface.
N.B. as explained in previous chapter 1–1 on page 23.
1–2.1.3 Operator skills and profile
In addition to skills stated in para.1–1.1.2 on page 23, the Operator must be familiar with all the equipmentfunctionalities.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
60
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–2.2 Summary of the SWP installation phases
The installation phases are:
a ) SW download to the NE, para.1–2.3 herebelow
b ) NE Login, para.1–2.4 on page 72
c ) Commissioning, para.1–2.5 on page 73
d ) Configuration data definition, para.1–2.6 on page 73
1–2.3 SW download to the NE
Through the suitable cable, connect the ECT to the F interface of the MAIN unit (see Fig. 157. on page251).
N.B. The software download can be performed also by using the Ethernet interface of the PC. TheECT must be connected to the Ethernet interface of the MAIN unit (see Fig. 157. on page 251).To activate the Ethernet connection refer to para. 1–1.4.2.2 on page 57. In this case thedownload will last only few minutes.
Step 1. Start the ECT
• Start → Alcatel 1320CT
Step 2. Install the current SWP on the platform environment
• On NES (Network Element Synthesis) start “SWP Administrator”: Supervision → FilesAdministration (SWP Administrator)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
61
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
• On SWP Administrator windows press install bottom
• Browse the SWP file descriptor “R94a.dsc” from the disk(C:\ALCATEL\JUSMw0.1.5\ect\swdw\R94AWY\1.0.0)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
62
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 3. Start Supervision
• On NES (Network Element Synthesis) start “Supervision”: Supervision → Start
Step 4. Show Equipment
• On NES (Network Element Synthesis) start “Show Equipment”: Supervision → ShowEquipment
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
63
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 5. Setup Server Access Configuration
• On JUSM start “Server Access Configuration”: SW Download → Server Access Configuration
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
64
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
• In the “FTP Login” window the field “Address” must be set with the same address written in“Alcatel Lower Layer Manager – IP Network – Local address”. Press “OK” to confirm.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
65
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Use System Default botton
When the operator click the Use System Default botton is possibile to set the field ADDRESS in twodifferent mode:
1) by F interface: to set IP address of the LLMAN to download in interface IF mode
2) by LAN interface: to set IP address of the PC to download the software in LAN mode
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
66
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 6. Init SW Download
• On JUSM start “Init SW Download”: SW Download → Init SW Download
• Wait “List Sw Package” creation ...
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
67
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
• When action is completed, press “Enter” to close message window.
• Now select a specific SWP to download on the NE, and press “Init download” to start it.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
68
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
• Confirm the start of software downloading:
• The software downloading in progress is shown by a specific window:
• When the download is over the following window is shown:
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
69
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 7. Activation of the new Software Package on the NE
• On JUSM start “SW Download”: SW Download → SW Download.
• After the software download, two software packages are present in the NE: one “Committed”and the other “Stand by”. The “NE Software Status Detail” window shows the information.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
70
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
• To activate the new software package select the software package in “Stand by Status”.
• Now select on “Software Management Action” field “Activation”.
• Press “Apply Action”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
71
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
• Confirm the selected action.
• After this window the NE restarts with the new software package.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
72
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–2.4 NE Login
a ) Cable connection
Through the suitable cable connect the ECT to the F interface or to the Ethernet interface of the MAINunit (refer to Fig. 157. on page 251).
To activate on the CT the connection through the Serial Port or through the Ethernet Port refer topara. 1–1.4.2 on page 57.
b ) Craft Terminal (CT) start–up
1 ) CT start :
– power on the CT and wait for PC start–up
– Start ⇒ Alcatel 1320CT:
• if choice Alcatel 1320CT is not available, PC is not configured as Craft Terminal:Software Package loading is necessary
after a while, the “Network Element Synthesis” screen will appear, showing all NetworkElements that can be selected. After this Start operation, all NEs appear with symbol “?”(it means they are not supervised)
N.B. For a corrected operation, only on some PC with Windows 2000 or XP by using theserial connection, it is necessary to start the Lower Layers Manager (Start →Programs → Alcatel → Lower Layers → Lower Layers Manager) before starting theECT Platform (Alcatel 1320CT).
c ) Start supervision on a selected Network Element (NE)
From screen “Network Element Synthesis” ( see point b ) – 1 ) ) :
1 ) select the interested Network Element (NE) clicking once left mouse button on it;
N.B. During the creation of the SNMP NE (refer to the 1320CT Basic Craft TerminalOperator’s Handbook, section 5 “EML CONSTRUCTION”), in the TCP/IP Port fieldnumber “161” must be inserted.
2 ) while NE selected, with right mouse button choose Start Supervision and with left mousebutton execute it (click once).
Wait until the symbol “?” becomes colored “•” (it means “NE in supervised state”)
N.B. The User Label of the NE must not include the following characters: \ ? : * “ < >|.
WARNING: Due to a deep fading the radio remote NE can be unreachable. In this condition in theUSM will appear the following message:
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
73
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– The USM must be closed.
In the NES will appear a broken icon and a red bullet.
– Wait for the automatic restarting of the Supervision (at the end of the fading conditions). The icon inNES will become whole and the bullet will take the color relevant to the alarms (if any) active in the NE.
– If the Supervision does not start, close and open again the CT.
– If the Supervision does not start, switch off and switch on the PC.
d ) Network Element login
From screen “Network Element Synthesis” with NE in supervised state ( see point c ) – 2 ) ):
1 ) select the interested Network Element (NE) clicking once right mouse button on it;
2 ) select Show Equipment. All the available menus are explained in Section 2.
WARNING: Before disconnecting the F interface cable or before switching off the NE, stop thesupervision and close the JUSM.
1–2.5 Commissioning
The commissioning instructions are given in:
9400AWY Line Up Guide
or
9400FSO Line Up Guide
1–2.6 Configuration data definition
The instructions given in the handbook cited in para. 1–2.5 above may not include the definition of all theEquipment configuration data that could be necessary.
In order to manage this data, refer to the Section 2 AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT on page 77.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
74
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
75
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
1–3 NE UPGRADE TO A NEWER SWP ’VERSION’ (SAME SWP ’RELEASE’)
This chapter details all phases necessary to install a new SWP ’version’ in the PC environment as wellas in the equipment environment.This procedure can be used only in the case depicted in point 3 ) on page 261, i.e.:
– ECT and equipment are running with one of the Software Packages with P/N indicated in Tab. 16. onpage 229 and with generic version ’A.B.c’ (’A.B’ is the SW release, ’c’ is the patch level)
– a new version of SWP ’A.B.d’ (d > c), having the same P/N, is delivered to Customer.
Procedure:
1 ) Requirements: see para.1–1.1 on page 23 and para.1–2.1 on page 59.
2 ) Carry out the installation of the new SWP version in the ECT environment, as indicated inchapter 1–1 on page 23.
3 ) The subsequent phases depend on the compatibility of MIB structure between previous andnew SWP versions. This MIB compatibility is indicated in the suitable chapter–paragraph(according to SWP Version) in Section 4 on page 227. In case you receive a version higher thanthe highest listed on page 227, please refer to the documentation accompanying the SWPdelivery to get this information.
N.B. Usually the MIB structure is fully compatible inside a SWP Release, so that thefollowing step 4 ) must be taken into consideration.
4 ) new MIB structure compatible with old MIB structure:
a ) perform the SW download with the following Craft Terminal commands (refer topara.2–13.2 on page 212 for detailed description):
• perform step 1 to 5 in para. 1–2.3 on page 60
• SW Download ⇒ Init SW download
• the screen of Fig. 148. on page 212 opens
• select the new NE–version to be downloaded
• with SWP Version 1.0.1 and 1.0.2 is necessary to select “Forced” option on CTscreen for SW Download activation request
• click on “Init download” button
• then, after about 1/2 hour, ⇒ SW Download ⇒ SW status ⇒ Apply Action to activatethe software.
N.B. The software download can be performed also by using the Ethernet interfaceof the PC. In this case the download lasts only few minutes.
b ) perform NE logoff followed by NE login.
The result is the Equipment working with the new SWP version nevertheless maintaining theold configuration data.
5 ) new MIB structure not compatible with old MIB structure
Procedure presently not necessary.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
76
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
77
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
SECTION 2: AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT
SECTION CONTENT PAGE
Chapter 2–1 – General introduction on views and menusThis chapter describes the organization of the 9400AWY/FSO ULS N.E.,presented after the NE login.
79
EQUIPMENT CONFIGURATION MANAGEMENT
Chapter 2–2 – ConfigurationThis chapter describes the configuration relevant to the equipment management.
89
Chapter 2–3 – EquipmentThis chapter deals with the presentation of the N.E. and the structure of thehierarchical tree, and the types of subracks and boards, that comprise the NetworkElement.
127
Chapter 2–4 – Line InterfaceThis chapter describes the operations necessary for the configuration setting andverification of each tributary.
137
Chapter 2–5 – RadioThis chapter deals with the management of the Radio transmission features.
143
Chapter 2–6 – FSOThis chapter deals with the management of the FSO transmission features.
153
Chapter 2–7 – External input and output pointsThis chapter describes how to display and set the input/output environmentalalarms (housekeeping alarms).
163
FUNCTIONS FOR MAINTENANCE
Chapter 2–8 – SupervisionThis chapter describes how to manage the NE access from OS or local ECT andhow to restart the NE.
167
Chapter 2–9 – Protection schemesThis chapter deals with the management of the Radio protections.
171
Chapter 2–10 – LoopbacksThis chapter describes the commands for loopback management, forcommissioning or maintenane purposes.
181
Chapter 2–11 – DiagnosisThis chapter describes how to access the Alarm and Event Log files and explainsthe Summary Block Diagram View menu.N.B. The chapter does not describe the Log Browser. Reference must be
done to the specific “ELB Operator’s Handbook”.
195
Chapter 2–12 – Performance MonitoringThis chapter deals with the use of the Performance Monitoring functionalities.
201
SOFTWARE MANAGEMENT
Chapter 2–13 – Software ManagementThis chapter deals with the management of the functions related to the softwareverification/download and to the back–up and restore of equipment configurationdata.
211
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
78
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
79
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–1 GENERAL INTRODUCTION ON VIEWS AND MENUS
This chapter describes the organization of the 9400 AWY/FSO N.E., presented after the NE login.
First the view organization is introduced, then the accessible menu options are listed.
Some further advices are given for Navigation principles.
N.B. This operator handbook explains the menus for Rel.1.0.0, Rel.1.0.1 and Rel. 1.0.2.Version 1.0.0 manages the Radio application only (1+0 configuration).Versions 1.0.1 and 1.0.2 manage the Radio application (1+0, 1+1 and 1+0 EXP configurations)and the FSO application.
2–1.1 9400 AWY/FSO view organization
The 9400 AWY/FSO view ( see Fig. 28. on page 80 ) contains the following fields, which provide theoperator with the information needed to manage the NE:
• Severity alarm synthesis,• Domain alarm synthesis,• Management status control panel,• View title,• View area,• Message/state area.
The Menu bar and the View area contained in the same NE view permit to perform all configuration andsupervision operations and the display the specific selected item.
The view organization is detailed in the Basic Craft Terminal Operator Handbook to which refer for thedescription.
N.B. Fig. 28. on page 80 shows the 9400 AWY in 1+1 configuration.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
80
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Menu bar
Viewarea
Severity alarmsynthesis
Domain alarm synthesis
Main toolbar
Management state control panel
Fig. 28. 9400 AWY Main view organization
N.B. For the meaning of the icons in the Severity alarm synthesis, Domain alarm synthesis and theManagement state control panel refer to Section 3 paragraph Alarm synthesis indication inthis handbook.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
81
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–1.1.1 View Area
The View Area manages all domains from which the user can start. It is organized into tabbed panel, e.g.many windows placed one upon another. Each window is selectable (placing it on top of the others) witha tab shown on the top.Each panel represents a set of functions. The area consist of the following sets:
– Equipment
– External Points
– Line Interface
– Performance
– Radio (or FSO in V 1.0.1 and V 1.0.2)
– Protection Schemes (for Radio application only in V 1.0.1 and V 1.0.2)
– Loopback
– Sw Download
The following figure shows the tabbed panel organization.
Each tab panel is labeled with the set name ( e.g. Equipment, Line Interface, etc ).
RESOURCETREE AREA
RESOURCE DETAIL AREA
RESOURCE LIST AREA
Fig. 29. View Areas
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
82
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Each tab–panel (e.g. functionalities area) consists of four areas:
– Resource–Tree Area: displays all the available resources of the Radio NE.
– Resource–List Area: may be represented by: Tabular View (e.g., Line Interface Domain) orGraphical View (e.g., Equipment Domain).
• Tabular View: displays a tabular representation of the selected resource. As default, no tabularelement is shown.
• Graphical View: displays a graphical representation of the selected resource. As default, notabular element is shown.
– Resource–Detail Area: displays detailed information of a selected item in the Resource List area.As a default, no entry view is displayed as a consequence of the default behavior of the ResourceList area.
2–1.1.2 Resource Tree Area
The “Resource Area” displays all the available resources in a tree structure like the protocol stackhierarchy. The below figure shows an example of the resource tree instance (for the Line Interfacefunctions):
Fig. 30. Resource tree area
2–1.1.2.1 Selection Criteria
Each tree node consists of two symbols. The first symbol indicates the state of the structure e.g., if thesymbol is ”+” the tree can be expanded to a lower level. The tree structure can be collapsed if the symbolis “–“. Finally, if there is no symbol, the node represents a leaf. The second symbol is the graphicalrepresentation of the resource.The user must select the resource by clicking with the mouse to carry out an action that depends on thetype of click.
Each resource listed above may be selected by using the mouse by a:
– Single left click;– Double left click
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
83
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Single left click:By a single left click the resource is highlighted. This selection causes the activation of theresource list area, e.g., every time the user selects a resource in the resource tree area thecorresponding Tabular or Graphical representation is displayed in the ”Resource list area” .
Double left click:Using this type of selection on the items of the resource tree, the user can expand the treestructure and activate the “Resource list area” displaying the same information describedabove. When the tree node is expanded a double click will collapsethe tree node showing thesame information in the “Resource list area”.
2–1.1.3 Resource Detail Area
This area displays the detailed information of the selected object in the Resource list area. It also providesthe types of operations available
2–1.1.4 Button Policy
The possible buttons for selection are the following:
– Apply this button activates the “modify”, but it does not close the window.
– Cancel this button closes the window without modifying the parameters displayed in the window.
– OK this button activates the modify and closes the window
– Close this button closes the window
– Help this button provides the help management for the functions of the supporting window.
Critical configuration choices should require a warning message for user confirmation before to beactivated.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
84
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–1.2 Introduction to the menu options
The menu bar allows to perform configuration and supervision functions on the Network Element.
This paragraph lists all menu options and then provides more details on the respective contained entries.
For each of them the relevant operative function are briefly introduced and it is referred the paragraphswhere they are detailed or the introduction to the options of each menu inserted in next paragraphs of thischapter.
From Chapter 2–2 on page 89 details and operating information on all views are given.
In the menu bar, a number of permanent menu items are always displayed. Starting from the left, themenus are:
– Permanent Menus
• Views (first column). See para.2–1.2.1 on page 85.
To navigate among the views and to set the TMN parameters.
• Configuration (second column). See para.2–1.2.2 on page 87.
To set the general configuration of the NE and to show or modify some parameters(performance monitoring, OverHead parameters).
• Diagnosis (third column). See para.2–1.2.3 on page 87.
To get information on the NE (alarms, performance monitoring, remote inventory).
• Supervision (fourth column). See para.2–1.2.4 on page 88.
To set the supervision states (i.e. Craft Terminal enabling).
• SW Download (fifth column). See para. 2–1.2.5 on page 88.
To manage the NE software (download, MIB management).
• Help (last column).
To activate the help on line.
The menu bar also comprises other menus, presented only when a specific option is selected.
– Other Menus
• Equipment
This menu is present only when the Equipment menu (selected in the View menu or in theEquipment tab panel) is active. It allows to go back to the supporting equipment of the displayedobject.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
85
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–1.2.1 Views menu introduction
The menu on the left side of the screen, allows to navigate among the views and to set some parameters,by means of the following entries:
– Previous: Goes back to the previous screen of the application.
– Open Object: Not active.
– Open in New Window: Not active.
– Duplicate View in New Window: Not active.
– Equipment: Opens the Equipment view.Then the “Equipment” menu is available on the menu bar.See Chapter 2–3 on page 127.
– External Points: Displays and sets the input/output environmental alarm.See Chapter 2–7 on page 163.
– Line Interface: Opens the Line Interface view to configure all the tributary ports.See Chapter 2–4 on page 137.
– Performance: Allows to manage the Performance monitoring.See Chapter 2–12 on page 201.
– Radio: Allows to manage all the functions relevant to the radio channels.See Chapter 2–5 on page 143.
– FSO: Allows to manage all the functions relevant to the FSO channel.See Chapter 2–6 on page 153.This menu is available in V 1.0.1 and V 1.0.2 only.
– Protection Scheme: Allows to manage the Protection schemes in 1+1 configuration.See Chapter 2–9 on page 171.This menu is available in V 1.0.1 and V 1.0.2 only for the Radio application.
– Loopback: Allows to manage the loopbacks available with the equipment.See Chapter 2–10 on page 181.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
86
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
N.B. It is possible to enter directly menus Equipment, External Points, Line Interface, Performance,Radio ( or FSO ), Protection Scheme, Loopback by clicking on the relevant tab panel above theview area. Refer to Fig. 31. on page 86.
Tab panel
Fig. 31. Tab panels
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
87
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–1.2.2 Configuration menu introduction
This menu allows to set the general configuration of the NE and to show or modify some parameters, bymeans of the following entries:
– NE Time: Displays and set the NE local time. See para. 2–2.1 on page 89.
– Network configuration: See para. 2–2.2 on page 90.
– Alarm Severities: Manages the Alarm Severity Assignment Profile.See para. 2–2.3 on page 101.
– System setting: Allows the system configuration, providing the setting of all the parametersfor the NE setup. See para. 2–2.4 on page 106.
– Quick configuration: Allows a full system configuration through a guided procedure.See para. 2–2.5 on page 113.
2–1.2.3 Diagnosis menu introduction
This menu allows to get information on the NE, by means of the following entries:
– Log Browsing: Manages the events stored in the NE.Opens the following menu options:• Alarm log• Event log• Software Trace logSee para. 2–11.1 on page 195.
– Current configurationView: Displays the current configuration of the NE.
See para. 2–11.2 on page 195.
– Summary Block Diagram View: Displays a global logical view (strictly related to the physical implementation)
highlighting a synthesis of all the alarms and statuses present in the system(ODU+IDU).See para. 2–11.4 on page 196.
– Abnormalcondition list: Displays the manually operations active in the NE.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
88
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–1.2.4 Supervision menu introduction
This menu allows to set the supervision states of the NE, by means of the following entries (see chapter2–8 on page 167) :
– Access State: Manages the supervision access to the NE, via CT or OS.Opens the following menu options:• OS• RequestedSee para. 2–8.1 on page 167.
– Restart NE: Reset of the NE software.See para. 2–8.2 on page 168.
– SW key: Displays the type of the key stored in the flash card.See para. 2–8.3 on page 169.
2–1.2.5 Download menu introduction
This menu allows to manage the NE software, by means of the following entries (see chapter 2–13 on page211) :
– Server Access Configuration: Manages the configuration of the FTP server to be used for the software
download to the NE.See para. 2–13.1 on page 211.
– Initi SW download: Manages the software download to the NE.See para. 2–13.2 on page 212.
– SW status: Shows and manages the status of the software packages installed in the NEmemory banks.See para. 2–13.3 on page 213.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
89
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2 CONFIGURATION
2–2.1 NE Time
The NE local time can be displayed and/or re–aligned to the OS time basis.
From the Configuration pull down menu, select the NE Time option.
The following dialogue box opens, from which you can set the local NE time.
Fig. 32. NE Time dialogue box
The NE Time dialogue box displays the current NE time and the current OS time.
To re–align the NE time to the OS time, click on the Set NE Time With OS Time check box and click theApply pushbutton to validate.
With a click on the Daylight Saving Time (DST) check box the manual management of the summer timetakes place.
The Refresh pushbutton allows to read the time actually present in the NE.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
90
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.2 Network Configuration
To get access the Network Configuration option select the Configuration pull down menu, as shownin the following figure.
Fig. 33. Network Configuration menu
The Network Configuration allows to perform the following operations:
Local Configuration: defines the local NE addresses
Ethernet Configuration: defines the configuration parameters necessary to managethe local NE providing a LAN Ethernet interface
IP Configuration which comprises:
IP static routing configuration: defines the Host/Network destination address for IP staticrouting
OSPF Area configuration: defines the Open Shortest Path First address
IP Address configuration ofPoint–To–Point Interfaces : defines the IP address of the interface which use the PPP
protocol
Routing information shows a summary of the information relevant to the routing which has been configured.
The options are described in next paragraphs.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
91
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.2.1 Local Configuration
Select the Configuration pull down menu.
Select the Network Configuration option and then, from the cascading menu, the Local Configurationoption.
The dialogue box opens ( see Fig. 34. on page 91 ) which allows to configure the local IP address of theNE.
This local IP address is the IP address associated to the F interface and to the other interfaces which usethe PPP protocol (the 3 NMS channels).
Apply button is used to perform a configuration change of the data contained in the dialogue box andcloses it; the dialogue is visible until the end of the operations and a wait cursor is displayed.
Close button closes the dialogue.
Help button provides some useful information on the dialogue.
Fig. 34. Local Configuration dialogue box
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
92
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.2.2 Ethernet Configuration
Select the Configuration pull down menu.
Select the Network Configuration option and then, from the cascading menu, the EthernetConfiguration option.
The dialogue box in Fig. 35. on page 92 opens, which allows to define the parameters necessary toconfigure the Ethernet interface.
The following areas are present:
– IP Section which comprises:
• IP Address to be assigned to the N.E.• IP Mask relevant to the IP address• IP Routing Protocol can be only in “ None” state.If “OSPF” or “ Both“ options of Routing IP
Protocol field are selected, also the “ Associated OSPF Area “ must be set.• OSPF Area poiner: if as IP Routing Protocol the OSPF protocol has been selected it is possible
to create OSPF areas.
– Enable which comprises two selections to Enable or Disable the Ethernet interface.
Refresh button refresh the information written in the upper port.Apply button performs a configuration change of the data.Close button closes the dialog without changes of the data.
Fig. 35. Ethernet Configuration dialogue box
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
93
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.2.3 IP Configuration
Select the Configuration pull down menu. Select the Network Configuration and then from thecascading menu, the IP Configuration option ( see Fig. 36. on page 93).
Fig. 36. IP configuration screen
2–2.2.3.1 IP static routing configuration
The dialog–box opens ( see Fig. 37. on page 94 ) and allows to configure the parameters for IP StaticRouting Configuration.
The following fields and data are present:
[1] IP Address: allows to define the IP address necessary to reach aspecific Host
[2] IP Mask: allows to define the IP Mask to reach a network
[3] Default Gateway IP Address: allows to define the address of the next hop gateway
[4] Interface type: allows to use point to point interfaces made availableby the NE.
Apply button is used to perform a configuration change of the data contained in the complete table andclose the view; the view is visible until the end of the operations and a wait cursor is displayed.
New button is used to insert a new page.
Delete button is used to delete the selected page.
Close button closes the dialogue without changing of the data.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
94
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 37. IP static routing configuration screen
By pressing Create pushbutton the screen in Fig. 38. on page 95 opens.
In the Host or Network Address Choice field select:
– Host to address to a single IP address;
– Network to address to a range of IP addresses.
In the Default Gateway or Point to Point I/F Choice select:
– Default Gateway IP Address for the Ethernet interface;
– Point to Point Interface Index for the NMS channels (NMS–RF, NMS–V11, NMS–G703)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
95
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 38. Create Static routing
If in the screen of Fig. 38. on page 95 the Default Gateway IP Address check box has been selected,write in the Default Gateway IP Address field below the relevant IP address.
If in screen in Fig. 38. on page 95 has been selected the Point To Point Interface Index check box,the screen in Fig. 39. on page 96 opens.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
96
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 39. Point To Point Interface Choice
In this screen one of the 3 NMS channels (NMS–RF, NMS–V11, NMS–G703) can be selected.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
97
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.2.3.2 OSPF Area configuration
The dialog–box opens ( see Fig. 40. on page 97 ) and allows to configure the parameters for OSPF(Open Shortest Path First) Area Table Configuration.
The following fields and data are present:
– OSPF Area IP Address– OSPF Area Range Mask– OSPF Area Stub
The fields give a synthetical information that includes all the addresses (specific to a NE and to a Network)in an Area.
Apply button is used to perform a configuration change of the data contained in the complete RAP tableand close the view; the view is visible until the end of the operations and a wait cursor is displayed.
New button is used to insert a new page.
Delete button is used to delete the selected page.
Close button closes the dialogue without changing of the data.
Fig. 40. OSPF Area configuration screen
WARNING: Area 0 is not managed.
By pressing Create pushbutton the screen in Fig. 41. on page 98 opens.
N.B. 3 areas max. can be created.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
98
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 41. Create New OSPF Area
In the screen write the IP address, the IP mask and select the flag (True/False).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
99
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.2.3.3 IP Address configuration of Point–To–Point Interfaces
The dialog–box opens ( see Fig. 42. on page 99 ) and allows to Enable or Disable the three NMSchannels, which use the PPP protocol.
OK button is used to perform a configuration change of the data contained in the dialog–box and closesit; the dialog is visible until the end of the operations and a wait cursor is displayed.
Cancel button close the dialog without changes of the data.
Fig. 42. IP Address configuration of Point–To–Point Interfaces screen
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
100
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.2.4 Routing information
Select the Configuration pull down menu. Select the Network Configuration and then from thecascading menu, the Routing information option.
The dialog–box in Fig. 43. on page 100 opens.
Fig. 43. Routing information screen
This screen is a read–only screen and displays the routing parameters currently active on the NE.
The pushbutton Refresh allows to refresh the information shown in the screen.
The Close button closes the dialogue without changing of the data.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
101
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.3 Alarm Severities
By selecting the Alarm Severities option from the Configuration menu the screen in Fig. 44. on page102 appears.
In this screen in the Profile Name field are listed the 4 default Alarm Severity Profiles:
– Profile “No Alarms”. With this profile all alarms are disabled.
– Profile “Primary Alarms”. This profile enables the emission of the primary alarms. General rulesused to define the alarms severity:
• MAJOR: the alarm affects the service (it is service affecting);
• MINOR or WARNING (according to the impact of the alarm): the alarm doesn’t affects theservice (with the exception of HighBER alarm, which MINOR alarm severity is defined, even ifit is service affecting).
– Profile “No Remote Alarms”. This profile enables the emission of the primary alarms plus EW andLBER alarm. This profile uses the following rules to define the alarms severity:
• MAJOR: the alarm affects the service (it is service affecting);
• MINOR: the alarm is potentially service affecting but a protection has recovered the service;
• WARNING: the alarm cannot affect the service (independently from any protection).
– Profile “All Alarms”. This profile enables the emission of all the alarms (included AIS and RDI). Thisprofile uses the same severity of the “Primary alarm” profile, the only difference is that EW, LBER,AIS and RDI alarms are emitted.The rules used to define the alarm severity are the same of the “Primary alarm” profile.
N.B. In case of alarms affecting a protection different severities are used for SA and NSA. The sameseverity is used both for SA and NSA in case of service independent alarms.
N.B. The rules used to define the profile alarms severity described above, are not applied to thehousekeeping alarms. In this case, in order to enhance the flexibility, a different severity isassigned to each alarm profile (WAR, MIN and MAJ).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
102
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 44. Alarm Severities Profile
In the screen of Fig. 44. on page 102 are available 2 buttons:
– Close: to close the screen.– Clone: to create a new Alarm Sevetiry Profile. To create a clone refer to para. 2–2.3.1 on page 103.
N.B. Only 2 new profiles can be created.
An Alarm Profile is the complete set of the equipment alarms with their severity in case of ServiceAffecting situation and No Service Affecting situation.
Each alarm has its Service Affecting and No Service Affecting attribute, which can differ according to theAlarm Severity Profile.
N.B. To some objects in the equipment (overhead alarm, input housekeeping alarm, tributaries etc.)can be assigned an Alarm Profile.To do this association:– select the tab panel (Equipment, Line Interface, FSO etc.) in which is present the object
to be associated to a specific Alarm Severity Profile;– select the object;– select the Configuration menu in the relevant Resource Detail Area;– select in the Alarm Profile field the Alarm Profile to be associated.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
103
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.3.1 How to create a new Alarm Severity Profile
– Select in the screen of Fig. 44. on page 102 the Alarm Profile to be cloned.
– Click the Clone pushbutton.
– The screen of Fig. 45. on page 103 appears.
– Digit the name to be assigned to the new Alarm Profile and click on Apply.
Fig. 45. Name of a cloned alarm profile
– Select again the Alarm Severity option from the Configuration menu.
– Select the just created Alarm Profile (Link 1 in the example of Fig. 46. on page 103).
Fig. 46. Clone of an Alarm Severity Profile
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
104
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– In this screen are available 4 buttons:
• Close: to close the screen without any change
• Rename: to change the name of the Alarm Severity Profile
• Modify: to modify the Alarm Severity Profile
• Delete: to delete the Alarm Severity Profile.
– Click on the Modify button.
– To modify the severity of an alarm click on the Service Affecting field click on the suitable alarm andselect a new severity (see Fig. 47. on page 104).
Fig. 47. Selection of a new severity in the Service Affecting field
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
105
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
– To modify the severity of an alarm click on the No Service Affecting field click on the suitable alarmand select a new severity (see Fig. 48. on page 105).
Fig. 48. Selection of a new severity in the No Service Affecting field
– To save the changes in the Alarm Severity Profile click on Apply. (By clicking on Cancel you quit theAlarm Severity Profile screen without any change) (see Fig. 48. on page 105).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
106
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.4 System Settings
This menu allows the system configuration, providing the setting of all the parameters for the NE setup.
The main window provides 3 tabbed–panels, one for each type of function to be managed:
– NE configuration (V 1.0.0 and V 1.0.1)– NE configuration (V 1.0.2)– Link Identifier– Overhead
WARNING: At the first configuration (i.e. with a flash card with an empty MIB) at the end of theconfiguration the “Restart NE” must be performed (refer to para. 2–8.2 on page 168).
WARNING: Should during this procedure to be selected a wrong type (i.e. PSU4860 instead of PSU24), to insert the correct type enter the System Settings menu → NE configuration tab panel; select the correct type; click on Apply and then restart the EC by entering menu Supervision and by activating command ”Restart NE”.
2–2.4.1 NE Configuration (V 1.0.0 and V 1.0.1)
The user can view and define the NE configuration by selecting the “NE Parameters” tabbed panel.The window displayed in Fig. 49. on page 106 will appear.The field “Type” contains all the allowed configurations supported for the NE (radio and FSO). Theoperator choice will be applied by selecting the related “Apply” button.The “Structure” area displays the market, capacity and modulation and, if needed, the ability to changeit, according to NE market configured in the previous screen.The field ”Market” contains two market types: ETSI or ANSI (refer to Tab. 1. and Tab. 2. ). The operatorchoice will be applied by clicking the related “Apply” button.
Fig. 49. System Settings: NE configuration (V 1.0.0 and V 1.0.1)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
107
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
The information related to the modulation type is shown in the “Modulation” field. The possible values are”4QAM” or ”16QAM”. The Capacity and the Modulation can be modified by selecting a different typeaccording to Tab. 1. for the Radio application and Tab. 2. for the FSO application and then selecting the”Apply” button to send the new value.
N.B. From 4QAM (PTMax) to 16QAM– the Alarm incompatible PTx is light ON– Tx Power value value is empty– to set new PTx value (range)– the Alarm incompatible PTx is light OFF
The “Tributary Port Configuration” area is in the lower part of the window. The “Impedance” field allowsthe operator to configure the impedance of the E1/DS1 tributary (unbalance 75 ohm or balance 120/100ohm).
The impedance value will be applied by clicking on the related ”Apply” button.
Tab. 1. Radio application: Market, capacity and modulation
Market Capacity Modulation
ETSI 2xE1 4QAM
4xE1 4QAM / 16QAM
8xE1 4QAM / 16QAM
16xE1 4QAM / 16QAM
1xE3 4QAM / 16QAM
ANSI 4xDS1 4QAM
8xDS1 4QAM / 16QAM
16xDS1 4QAM / 16QAM
1xDS3 4QAM / 16QAM
Tab. 2. FSO application: Market, capacity and modulation
Market Capacity Modulation
ETSI 16xE1 4QAM
1xE3 4QAM
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
108
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.4.2 NE Configuration (V 1.0.2)
The user can view and define the NE configuration by selecting the “NE Parameters” tabbed panel.
The window displayed in Fig. 49. on page 106 will appear.
The field “Type” contains all the allowed configurations supported for the NE (radio and FSO). Theoperator choice will be applied by selecting the related “Apply” button.
The “Structure” area displays the market, capacity and modulation and, if needed, the ability to changeit, according to NE market configured in the previous screen.
The field ”Market” contains two market types: ETSI or ANSI (refer to Tab. 1. and Tab. 2. ). The operatorchoice will be applied by clicking the related “Apply” button.
Fig. 50. System Settings: NE configuration (V 1.0.2)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
109
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
The information related to the modulation type is shown in the “Modulation” field. The possible values are”4QAM” or ”16QAM”. The operator choice will be applied by clicking the related “Apply” button.
N.B. From 4QAM (PTMax) to 16QAM– the Alarm incompatible PTx is light ON– Tx Power value value is empty– to set new PTx value (range)– the Alarm incompatible PTx is light OFF
The Capacity can be modified by selecting a different type according to Tab. 1. for the Radio applicationand Tab. 2. for the FSO application and then selecting the ”Apply” button to send the new value.
N.B. After a change in the “Type” or “Market” or “Capacity” or “Modulation” field the explicitconfirmation shown in Fig. 51. is requested.
Fig. 51. Confirmation message
N.B. Only one change can be performed in this screen. When the user confirms the change in the “Type” or “Market” or “Capacity” or “Modulation” fieldall the other fields are disabled. To perform another change close the screen and enter again.
N.B. After a change in the “Type” or “Market” or “Capacity” or “Modulation” field (for the “Modulation”only for the remote NE configuration) at the completion of the operation the CT forces the JUSMclosing with the following warning message (see Fig. 52. ).
Fig. 52. USM closing warning message
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
110
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
The “Tributary Port Configuration” area is in the lower part of the window. The “Impedance” field allowsthe operator to configure the impedance of the E1/DS1 tributary (unbalance 75 ohm or balance 120/100ohm).
The impedance value will be applied by clicking on the related ”Apply” button.
Tab. 3. Radio application: Market, capacity and modulation
Market Capacity Modulation
ETSI 2xE1 4QAM
4xE1 4QAM / 16QAM
8xE1 4QAM / 16QAM
16xE1 4QAM / 16QAM
1xE3 4QAM / 16QAM
ANSI 4xDS1 4QAM
8xDS1 4QAM / 16QAM
16xDS1 4QAM / 16QAM
1xDS3 4QAM / 16QAM
Tab. 4. FSO application: Market, capacity and modulation
Market Capacity Modulation
ETSI 16xE1 4QAM
1xE3 4QAM
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
111
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.4.3 Link Indentifier
The ”Link Identifier” area, shown in Fig. 53. on page 111, displays the current values of parametersrelated to link management and, if necessary, modifies them.
The operator choices will be sent to NE by clicking on the related “Apply” button. The parameters involvedare:
– Mismatch detection: this field disables or enables the link identifier mismatch detection.
– Expected Value: this field is the link identifier value expected by the NE (allowed values: 1 to 16).
– Sent Value: this field is the link identifier value transmitted by the NE (allowed values: 1 to 16).
Fig. 53. System Settings: Link Identifier
The operator choice will be applied by selecting the related “Apply” button.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
112
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.4.4 Overhead
The ”Overhead” tabbed panel identifies the parameters for the management of the phone number andauxiliary interface (Fig. 54. on page 112).
Fig. 54. Overhead Configuration
The field ”Phone Number” in the ”Order Wire Configuration” area allows the operator to read and writethe station number associated to the Engineering Order Wire to be used in the selective call. Possiblevalues are: 10–99.
N.B. Number 00 is the value associated to the general call.
The parameter will be sent to NE by clicking on the related “Apply” button.
The field ”Type” in the ”Auxiliary Interface Configuration” area allows the operator to change theinterface of the auxiliary channels.The parameter will be sent to NE by clicking on the related “Apply” button.
The field Alarm Profile allows to associate to the Overhead alarms a particular Alarm Profile: a defaultalarm profile or an Alarm Profile previously created by the Operator (refer to para. 2–2.3.1 on page 103).To associate a different Alarm Profile click on the selection button and make the selection among theavailable Alarm Profiles.
N.B. the default associated Alarm Profile is the Primary Alarm profile.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
113
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–2.5 Quick Configuration Procedure
This procedure allows a full system configuration through a guided process, based on a reduced set ofscreens. The related windows will be displayed by a “Wizard Tool” according to a specific order.
To start this application, select the “Quick Configuration” option from the “Configuration” menu. Thewindow in Fig. 55. on page 114 will appear. This window is the first step of the procedure.
The procedure consists of different steps according to the configuration:
– 1+0 configuration:
• 6 steps for the simplified configuration
• 12 steps for the advanced configuration (the advanced configuration can be activated in step5)
– 1+1 configuration:
• 7 steps for the simplified configuration
• 13 steps for the advanced configuration (the advanced configuration can activated in step 6)
Note on the use of the buttons available in the screens:
– Back: by clicking on this button the procedure goes back to the previous step
– Next: by clicking on this button the procedure goes on the next step
– Finish: this button is active only in the last step. By clicking on this button the operator confirms theconfiguration and the new parameters are sent to the equipment.
– Cancel: by clicking on this button the operator quits the procedure without any change in theconfiguration.
– Help: by clicking on this button the operator calls the help–on line.
In the following is explained step by step the most complete procedure for 1+1 configuration.
WARNING: At the first configuration (i.e. with a flash card with an empty MIB) at the end of theconfiguration the “Restart NE” must be performed (refer to para. 2–8.2 on page 160).
WARNING: Should during this procedure to be selected a wrong type (i.e. PSU4860 instead of PSU24), to insert the correct type enter the System Settings menu → NE configuration tab panel; select the correct type; click on Apply and then restart the EC by entering menu Supervision and by activating command ”Restart NE”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
114
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 1
Fig. 55. Quick Installation Procedure: NE Configuration (Step 1)
The first step provides a screen to configure two NE parameters:– Market (ETSI or ANSI); for FSO application the market is ETSI only;– Type configuration.
The possible selections for the Type field are:– Radio application:
• 1+0 (PSU24 or PSU4860): unprotected configuration• 1+1 HST (PSU24 or PSU4860): Hot Standby protected configuration• 1+1 FD (PSU24 or PSU4860): Frequency Diversity protected configuration• 1+0 HST EXP (PSU24 or PSU4860): Hot Standby extendable configuration• 1+0 FD EXP (PSU24 or PSU4860): Frequency Diversity extendable configuration
– FSO application:• 1+0 FSO (PSU24,PSU4860,PSUM4860H): unprotected configuration
The market choice implies a first selection of possible frame structure. The type definition implies theequipment configuration and other related functions: for example, the protection schemes supported.
N.B. for V 1.0.2 only: For the Remote NE in this step the Type and the Market cannot be modified. To modify them the System Settings menu must be used (refer to para. 2–2.4.2on page 108).
To go to step 2 click on button “Next”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
115
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 2
The screen shown in Fig. 56. on page 115 provides the fields to set the Structure of the Frameconfiguration (Capacity and Modulation).
The capacity implies the choice of modulation; for example, if the tributary structure is 2E1 (for ETSImarket) only 4QAM modulation scheme is supported.
N.B. The association between Capacity and Modulation is shown in Tab. 1. and Tab. 2. on page 107.
Moreover, if the tributary selected is E1 the Impedance also must be selected in the Tributary PortConfiguration (unbalance 75 ohm or balance 120 ohm).
Fig. 56. Quick Installation Procedure: Frame Configuration (Step 2)
In the screen displayed in Fig. 56. on page 115 (and in the following Steps), the “Back” button is enabledalso. It allows the operator to turn back and change the parameters configured in the previous screen.
N.B. in FSO application the applicable capacity is 16E1 or E3 only and modulation is 4 QAM only.
N.B. for V 1.0.2 only: For the Remote NE in this step the Capacity and the Modulation cannot bemodified. To modify them the System Settings menu must be used (refer topara. 2–2.4.2 on page 108).
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
116
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 3
Step 3 allows the operator to choose, for each tributary configured, the signal mode or disable it(Fig. 57. on page 116).
Fig. 57. Quick Installation Procedure: Tributaries Configuration (Step 3)
By clicking on the one facility button (“All Framed”, “All Unframed” and “All Disabled”), the operator canconfigure all the tributaries with the same values; otherwise he can apply all configuration for each tributaryby selecting the related value from the relevant scroll list.
N.B. This procedure can be used also after the first configuration to perform multiple changes in theconfiguration both in the local and in the remote NE.
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
117
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 4
Step 4 allows the operator to choose the restoration criteria (revertive or not revertive for the 3 possibleprotections available in the 1+1 configuration (Fig. 58. on page 117):
– Radio protection (Rx EPS)
– Mux protection (Tx EPS)
– HST Tx protection (RF Hot Stand–by)
Fig. 58. Quick Installation Procedure: Tributaries Configuration (Step 4)
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
118
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 5
Step 5 allows the operator to define the basic paramters for each configured channel. The related screenis shown in the Fig. 59. on page 118:
Fig. 59. Quick Configuration Procedure: Channels Configuration (Step 5)
In the Channel Configuration area the ATPC can be Enabled or Disabled. If enabled, the other ATPCparameters (min. value, max. value and Rx threshold) must be configured in RTPC & ATPC menu in theRadio domain (refer to para. 2–5.4 on page 146).
If ATPC is disabled in the RTPC area the power (costantly transmitted) can be selected by writing thesuitable value in the Tx power field.
In the Frequency Value area the Tx operating frequency must be written in the Tx Freq field.
N.B. for V 1.0.2 only: The Tx Frequency value can be changed only on the Local NE (To change theTx frequency for the Remote NE use the Radio menu – refer to para. 2–5.3on page 145).
The Rx Frequency is automatically changed according to the frequency shifter available with the ODU.
All the values must be selected according to the relevant allowed ranges (shown between brackets).
N.B. In case of 1+1HST the choices will be applied to both “channels”. In case of 1+1FD, the samescreen will be reproposed for channel 0 with the same choices applied for channel 1, with thepossibility to change the frequency, but without any possibility to change ATPC/RTPC selection.
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
119
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 6
Step 6 performs the network configuration (Fig. 60. on page 119). This window allows to enter to IPaddress associated to the F interface of the NE.
N.B. for V 1.0.2 only: The IP Address can be changed only on the Local NE (To change the IPAddress for the Remote NE use the menu Configuration → NetworkConfiguration → Local Configuration – refer to para. 2–2.2.1 on page 91).
Fig. 60. Quick Configuration Procedure: Local IP Address (Step 6)
For an advanced network configuration the operator must select the “Advanced Configuration” flag.
If the flag has been selected, the screens in the next steps allow the operator to perform a completeconfiguration of all the Network parameters.
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
120
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 7
Step 7 allows to configure one or more OSPF Areas (3 areas max.) (Fig. 61. on page 120).
Fig. 61. Quich Installation Procedure: OSPF Area Configuration (Step 7)
To create a new area write a number in the Area Id field, in the IP address field write the address and inthe Range Mask field enter the range associated to the OSPF area and click on Add button.
If the OSPF area must be a stub area, make the selection in the Stub Area check box.
In the upper part of the screen the new OSPF area will appear.
To remove or change an OSPF Area Configuration select the Area in the upper part and click on Removeor Change button.
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
121
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 8
The following windows for Network Configuration allow the complete IP configuration.
Step 8 configures one or more Static Routers (Fig. 62. on page 121).
Fig. 62. Quick Installation Procedure: IP Static Router Configuration (Step 8)
The following fields and data are present:
[1] Host Address: allows to define the IP address necessary to reach a specific Host.
[2] Network Address: it is in alternative to the Host Address; allows to define the IP Mask to reacha network.
[3] Gateway Address: allows to define the address of the next hop gateway.
[4] PPP: it allows to use the point to point interfaces (the 3 NMS channels) availablewith the NE.
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
122
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 9
Step 9 allows the configuration of the NMS–RF channel (Fig. 63. on page 122):
Fig. 63. Quick Configuration Procedure: NMS–RF Interface Configuration (Step 9)
The “NMS–RF” interface is a communication interface based on the use of an inframe RF proprietary 64kbit/s channel. Through the “NMS–RF” interface the NE can exchange management messages with aremote OS (or Craft Terminal) station.
The NMS–RF channel can be Enabled or Disabled by selection in the NMS RF field.
If enabled, in the Remote Address field will appear the IP address of the remote connected NE.
In the Routing IP Protocol field enter the used IP protocol and in case of OSPF protocol select also theassociated OSPF area.
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
123
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 10
Step 10 allows the configuration of the NMS–V11 interface (Fig. 64. on page 123):
Fig. 64. Quick Configuration Procedure: NMS–V11 Interface Configuration (Step 10)
Through the “NMS–V11” interface the NE can exchange management messages with an OS (or CraftTerminal) in the same station.
The NMS–V11 channel can be Enabled or Disabled by selection in the NMS V11 field.
If enabled, in the Remote Address field will appear the IP address of the remote connected NE.
In the Routing IP Protocol field enter the used IP protocl and in case of OSPF protocol select also theassociated OSPF area.
In the PPP_MODE field the following selections can be made:
– DTE mode:to interface an SDH service channel, where DCE mode is not available because of the commonsynchronisation of the SDH network.
– Co–directional mode:to allow the routing of the LUX40 NMS, avoiding the needed V11/Eth adapter or to link adjacent AWY.
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
124
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 11
Step 11 allows the configuration of the NMS–G703 interface (Fig. 65. on page 124):
Fig. 65. Quick Configuration Procedure: NMS–G703 Interface Configuration (Step 11)
Through the “NMS–G703” interface the NE can exchange management messages with an OS (or CraftTerminal) in the same station.The NMS–G703 channel can be Enabled or Disabled by selection in the NMS G703 field.If enabled, in the Remote Address field will appear the IP address of the remote connected NE.In the Routing IP Protocol field enter the used IP protocl and in case of OSPF protocol select also theassociated OSPF area.In the PPP_MODE field the following selections can be made:
– DTE mode:to interface an SDH service channel, where DCE mode is not available because of the commonsynchronisation of the SDH network.
– Co–directional mode:to link adjacent AWY or to interface MUX based on 64 kbit/s, avoiding any V.11/G.703 adapter.
– In frame E1–DS1 mode:as alternative mode is possible to drop in the G703 64 kbit/s in Tributary 1, Time Slot 1 allowing thetransport of supervision messages along the traffic path.
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
125
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 12
Step 12 (Fig. 66. on page 125) allows to configure the Ethernet Interface.
Fig. 66. Quick Installation Procedure: Ethernet Configuration (Step 12)
The Ethernet interface can be Enabled or Disabled by selection in the Ethernet configuration field.
If enabled, in the relevant fields below enter the IP address, the IP mask and select the Routing IPprotocol. If the selected routing protocol has been OSPF, select also the area number in the AssociatedOSPF Area field.
To go to the next step click on button “Next”.
To go back to the previous step click on button “Back”.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
126
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Step 13
Step 13 is the last step. The screen shown summarizes all the parameters configured during thisprocedure and some relevant parameters with default values (Fig. 67. on page 126).
Fig. 67. Quick Configuration Procedure: Summary (Step 13)
All the parameters can still be changed by clicking on the “Back” button. The operator can navigate backto the desired screen and set the new values.
At the end the operator can confirm the selections by pressing the “Finish” button. All the parameters willbe stored and sent to the NE.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
127
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–3 EQUIPMENT
This chapter describes the types of functions offered to the user for Equipment Management.
N.B. Please refer to Appendix A on page 243 for the detailed description of equipment functions andcomponents.
The equipment domain deals with the management of the NE as a whole and its physical components(subrack, boards,..)
The main screen of the Equipment tab panel is shown in Fig. 68. on page 127 for 1+0 FSO configuration.
The main screen of the Equipment tab panel is shown in Fig. 69. on page 128 for 1+0 Radio configuration.
The main screen of the Equipment tab panel is shown in Fig. 70. on page 128 for 1+1 Radio configuration.
In the Resource List Area is shown a graphical representation of the Equipment, which consists of an IDUand an ODU.
A coloured ball gives information on the status of the associated object. The colour differs according tothe severity of the alarms:
– Green: no alarm– White: indetermination alarm active (not operative)– Cyanic: warning alarm active– Yellow: minor alarm active– Brown: major alarm active– Red: critical alarm active
IDU
FSO ODU
IDU Status
ODU Status
Equipment Status
Fig. 68. 1+0 FSO Equipment view
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
128
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
IDU
ODU
IDU Status
ODU Status
Equipment Status
Fig. 69. 1+0 Radio Equipment view
IDU
ODU
IDU Status
Equipment Status
ODU Status
Fig. 70. 1+1 Radio Equipment view
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
129
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 71. 1+0 EXP Radio Equipment view
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
130
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–3.1 IDU level
To enter the IDU level click on the IDU object in the Resource Tree Area or double click on the IDU imagein the Resource Detail Area.
2–3.1.1 1+0 configuration
Configuration available both with 9400AWY and 9400FSO.
The screen in Fig. 72. on page 130 will appear.
IDU
MAIN BOARDStatus
ACCESS BOARD StatusIDU Status
ACCESS BOARDMAIN BOARD
Fig. 72. 1+0 IDU view
The IDU consists of 2 boards:
– Access board
– Main board
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
131
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–3.1.2 “1+0 extendable” and “1+1” configuration
Configurations available with 9400AWY only.
The screen in Fig. 73. on page 131 will appear.
IDU
MAIN BOARDStatus
IDU Status
ACCESS BOARDMAIN BOARD
EXTENSIONBOARDStatus
EXTENSION BOARD
ACCESS BOARD Status
FANSBOARDStatus
FANS BOARD
Fig. 73. 1+1 IDU view
The IDU consists of 4 boards:– Access board– Main board– Extension board (not present in “1+0 extendable” configuration)– Fans board
2–3.1.3 Procedure for configuration change from “1+0 extendable” to “1+1”
There are many ways to proceed for this configuration change, but some of them give no good results.Thus, follow this procedure to obtain a correct result, without traffic impacts:
1 ) Install the second ODU unit and the relevant IDU–ODU cable (refer to 9400AWY InstallationHandbook)
2 ) On IDU, extract the dummy plate closing the Extension board slot3 ) Get the Extension board, switch off it, insert it in the shelf and connect the IDU–ODU cable4 ) Set, by Local ECT, 1+1 configuration using System Setting function5 ) Restart the NE6 ) Switch on the Extension board7 ) Proceed as specified in the 9400AWY Installation Handbook and Line–Up Guide for the
operations regarding the second ODU installed. In particular, set, by Local CT, Tx Power andTx Frequency values related to second ODU.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
132
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–3.1.4 Board level
To enter a board click on the object in the Resource Tree Area or double click on the board image in theResource Detail Area.
As example in Fig. 74. on page 132 is shown the screen of the MAIN IDU board.
BOARD Status
Fig. 74. Main board view
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
133
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–3.2 ODU level
To enter the ODU level click on the ODU object in the Resource Tree Area or double click on the ODUimage in the Resource Detail Area.The screen in Fig. 75. on page 133 will appear in case of FSO configuration.The screen in Fig. 76. on page 133 will appear in case of Radio configuration.
Fig. 75. FSO ODU view
Fig. 76. Radio ODU view
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
134
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–3.3 Tab panels in the Resource Detail Aarea
2–3.3.1 Alarms
The Alarms tab panel provides the fault mangement, which checks the current state of alarms related tothe selected object (Fig. 77. on page 134).
Fig. 77. Alarm tab panel for a selected object
The alarm tab panel has one row for each possible alarm, but only rows related to the active alarms arehighlighted. When the alarm disappears it is automatically cleared in the screen.
By putting a tick in the Include alarms from sub–nodes box the alarms currently active in the sub–nodesof the object will also appear.
For every alarm the following information is given:
– Severity: the severity associated to the alarm and assigned in the Alarm Profile
– Event Time: the time of the generation of the alarm
– Entity: the entity involved in the alarm
– Probable Cause: the probable cause of the alarm
– Managed Object Class: the class of the alarm.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
135
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–3.3.2 Configuration
The “User Label”’ field (Fig. 78. ) only display the label associated to the selected node in the tree.
The field Alarm Profile allows to associate to the object alarms a particular Alarm Profile: a default alarmprofile or an Alarm Profile previously created by the Operator (refer to para. 2–2.3.1 on page 103). Toassociate a different Alarm Profile click on the selection button and make the selection among the availableAlarm Profile.
N.B. the default associated Alarm Profile is the Primary Alarm profile.
Fig. 78. Configuration tab panel for a selected object
2–3.3.3 Remote Inventory
The information about the unit can be read in the Remote Inventory panel in the Resource Detail Areaas following window shows (Fig. 79. on page 135):
Fig. 79. Remote Inventory tab panel for a selected object
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
136
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
137
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–4 LINE INTERFACE
This chapter describes the type of functions available for Line Interface Management.The Line Interface domain deals with the management of the aggregate frame and tributary ports (lineside).The Line Interface view allows the user to manage the resources of a PDH signal, i.e. frames, tributaryports (line), etc.This domain view consists of the following areas (Fig. 80. on page 137):
– Resource Tree Area: displays the frames and tributary ports sorted by the channel number.– Resource List Area: displays tabular information about the selected resource in the tree area.– Resource Detail Area: displays, through tabbed windows, the selected object’ s properties in list
area. This area performs the available functions for involved resource.
Fig. 80. Line Interface View
In the Resource List Area is given the information related to the tributaries:
– Type Interface (E1/E3, DS1/DS3)– Port Number: the port for a given channel and type of port– Channel Number: the number of a channel– Rate/Modulation: the bit rate of the tributary– Signal Mode: the type of frame (Unframed/Framed/Disabled)
To change the Signal Mode select the tributary and change the Signal Mode field in the Resource DetailArea.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
138
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–4.1 Tab panels in the Resource Detail Area
2–4.1.1 Alarm
The fault mangement checks the current state of alarms related to the selected tributary.
It is provided by the alarm panel like the one explained in para. 2–3.3.1 on page 134.
2–4.1.2 Configuration
2–4.1.2.1 E1/E3 tributaries
The window, shown in Fig. 81. on page 138 and Fig. 82. on page 138, performs all available functions fora tributary port.
The managed tributary types are: E1, E3.
To define the involved ports, the channel selection in the tree view is first required; therefore the selectionof the desired tributary port in the tabular view enables the “Resource Detail list” to show the availablefunctions for the single one resource.
Fig. 81. Line Interface View: E1 Tributary Port
Fig. 82. Line Interface View: E3 Tributary Port
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
139
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
In Fig. 81. on page 138 and Fig. 82. on page 138 the following fields are read only fields:
– Interface Type (E1, E3)
– Port Number: identifies the ports for a given channel and type of port
– Channel Number
The fields, which can be changed, are:
– Signal Mode
– Tx RAI Insertion
– Rx RAI Insertion
– Alarm Profile
Signal Mode (for E1 tributary)
The possible values are:
– Framed for the framed received signal
– Unframed for the unframed received signal
– Disabled
The current state can be modified selecting a different signal mode value and then click on the ”Apply”button to send the new value to NE.
Signal Mode (for E3 tributary)
The possible values are:
– Framed G.751 for the framed received signal
– Framed G.753 for the framed received signal (not applicable)
– Unframed for the unframed received signal
– Disabled
The current state can be modified selecting a different signal mode value and then click on the ”Apply”button to send the new value to NE.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
140
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Tx RAI Insertion (for E1 tributary only)
This feature is available for framed signals only.
This field refers to the insertion of the RAI signal in Tx side. The possible values are:
– Inibited: it is not possible to force the RAI insertion
– Forced: the RAI insertion is performed
– Enabled: the RAI insertion is possible.
The current state can be modified selecting a different signal mode value and then click on the ”Apply”button to send the new value to NE.
Rx RAI Insertion (for E1 tributary only)
This feature is available for framed signals only.
This field refers to the insertion of the RAI signal in Rx side. The possible values are:
– Inibited: it is not possible to force the RAI insertion
– Forced: the RAI insertion is performed
– Enabled: the RAI insertion is possible.
The current state can be modified selecting a different signal mode value and then click on the ”Apply”button to send the new value to NE.
Alarm Profile
The field Alarm Profile allows to associate to the tributary alarms a particular Alarm Profile: a default alarmprofile or an Alarm Profile previously created by the Operator (refer to para. 2–2.3.1 on page 103). Toassociate a different Alarm Profile click on the selection button and make the selection among the availableAlarm Profile.
N.B. the default associated Alarm Profile is the No Alarm profile.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
141
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–4.1.2.2 DS1/DS3 tributaries
The window, shown in Fig. 83. on page 141 and Fig. 84. on page 141, performs all available functions fora tributary port.
The managed tributary types are: DS1, DS3.
To define the involved ports, the channel selection in the tree view is first required; therefore the selectionof the desired tributary port in the tabular view enables the “Resource Detail list” to show the availablefunctions for the single one resource.
Fig. 83. Line Interface View: DS1 Tributary Port
Fig. 84. Line Interface View: DS3 Tributary Port
In Fig. 83. on page 141 and Fig. 84. on page 141 the following fields are read only fields:
– Interface Type (DS1/DS3)– Port Number: identifies the ports for a given channel and type of port– Channel Number
The fields, which can be changed, are:
– Signal Mode– Line Coding (AMI/B8ZS: for DS1 tributary only)– Line length (0–133,133–266, 266–399, 399–533, 533–655: for DS1 tributary only)– Alarm Profile
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
142
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Signal Mode (for DS1 tributary)
The possible values are:
– Framed SF for the Super Framed received signal– Framed ESF for the Extended Super Framed received signal– Unframed for the unframed received signal– Disabled
The current state can be modified selecting a different signal mode value and then click on the ”Apply”button to send the new value to NE.
Signal Mode (for DS3 tributary)
The possible values are:
– Framed for the framed received signal– Unframed for the unframed received signal– Disabled
The current state can be modified selecting a different signal mode value and then click on the ”Apply”button to send the new value to NE.
Line Coding (for DS1 tributary only)
This field refers to the coding relevant to the tributary signal. The possible values are:
– B8ZS– AMI
The current state can be modified selecting a different signal mode value and then click on the ”Apply”button to send the new value to NE.
Line Length (for DS1 tributary only)
This field refers to the length of the connected line. The possible values are:
– 0–133– 133–266– 266–399– 399–533– 533–655
The current state can be modified selecting a different signal mode value and then click on the ”Apply”button to send the new value to NE.
Alarm Profile
The field Alarm Profile allows to associate to the tributary alarms a particular Alarm Profile: a default alarmprofile or an Alarm Profile previously created by the Operator (refer to para. 2–2.3.1 on page 103). Toassociate a different Alarm Profile click on the selection button and make the selection among the availableAlarm Profile.
N.B. the default associated Alarm Profile is the No Alarm profile.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
143
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–5 RADIO
The Radio domain view allows the user to manage the resources of the radio transmission channel.
A Radio NE consists of one or two radio channels with a set of functional blocks (tributary ports, radio portsetc).
This domain view consists of the following areas (Fig. 85. on page 143):
– Resource Tree Area: displays the radio ports sorted by channel number.
– Resource List Area: displays tabular information about the selected resource in tree area.
– Resource Detail Area: displays, through tabbed windows, the object’ s properties selected in thelist area. This area enables to execute the available functions for involved resource.
Fig. 85. Radio Domain View
Five tab panels are present in the Resourse Detail Area:
– Alarms: shows the active alarms (refer to para. 2–5.1 on page 144)– Configuration: configures some radio parameters (refer to para. 2–5.2 on page 144)– Frequency: sets the Tx RF frequency (refer to para. 2–5.3 on page 145)– RTPC & ATPC: sets the manual operation parameters or the automatic operation parameters (refer
to para. 2–5.4 on page 146)– Power Meas: performs the Tx and Rx power measurements (refer to para. 2–5.5 on page 147).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
144
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–5.1 Alarm
The fault mangement allows to check the current state of alarms related to the selected object.
It is provided by the alarm panel like that shown in para. 2–3.3.1 on page 134.
2–5.2 Configuration
The window shown in Fig. 94. on page 154 performs all the available functions for a Radio PDH port.To define the involved port, first select the port/channel in the tabular view: this selection enables the“Resource Detail list” to show the available functions for the single resource.
2–5.2.1 Local or Remote Transmitter Mute
The information related to the transmitter status is shown in the “Tx Mute” field. To change the transmitterstatus choose the desired value (ON for Tx Squelched and OFF for Tx not Squelched) and press therelated “Apply” button.
2–5.2.2 ODU service kit
This field is a read–only field, which displays the state of the Portable Service Kit (connected or not to theODU).
2–5.2.3 Alarm Profile
The field Alarm Profile allows to associate a particular Alarm Profile to the object alarms: a default alarmprofile or an Alarm Profile previously created by the Operator (refer to para. 2–2.3.1 on page 103). Toassociate a different Alarm Profile click on the selection button and select among the available AlarmProfile.
N.B. the default associated Alarm Profile is the Primary Alarm profile.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
145
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–5.3 Frequency
This menu (Fig. 86. on page 145) allows to read and, if necessary, to set the frequency parameters.
The information shown concerns the port/channel selected in the Resource Tabular View.
Fig. 86. Radio Frequency menu
2–5.3.1 Tx Radio Frequency
The ”Tx Freq” field in the “Frequency Value” area of tabbed window (Fig. 86. on page 145) shows thecurrent value of the transmission radio frequency (expressed in kHz). To change this parameter write thenew value in the field and press the ”Apply” button.
The new value must be within the allowed radio frequency range. The allowed range is shown in “Min/MaxValue” fields.
N.B. During the command setting the CT is frozen. Waiting time: max. 30’.
2–5.3.2 Rx Radio Frequency
The ”Rx Freq” field in the “Frequency Value” area of the tabbed window (Fig. 86. on page 145) shows thecurrent value of the receive radio frequency (expressed in kHz).
It is automatically changed as a consequence of the definition of the Tx frequency according to theFrequency Shifter.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
146
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–5.4 RTPC & ATPC
This menu (Fig. 87. on page 146) allows to read and, if necessary, to set the Tx power parameters.The shown information is related to the channel selected in the Resource Tabular View.
Fig. 87. Rtpc & Atpc
2–5.4.1 ATPC
The ATPC can be Enabled or Disabled.The new value will be applied when the ”Apply” button is pressed. If the ATPC has been enabled, theATPC Range and ATPC Rx Threshold fields must be filled.
2–5.4.2 Tx Nominal Power
The “Nominal Value” field in the “RTPC” area (Fig. 87. on page 146) is a read–only field and shows thenominal value of the transmitted power (expressed in dBm).
2–5.4.3 Tx Current Power
The “Tx Power” field in the “RTPC” area (Fig. 87. on page 146) shows the current value of Tx power(expressed in dBm), when the ATPC is disabled . In this case, it is possible to modify this value ERRORFREE in ATPC Range (Pnom –20 db) with 2 dB max step allowed, by writing the new value and by pressingthe related “Apply” button.
N.B. During the command setting the CT is frozen. Waiting time: < 15’.The new value must be within the allowed transmitted power range. This range is shown in the “PowerValue” label of “RTPC” area.If the Atpc is enabled, the Tx power value cannot be modified.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
147
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–5.4.4 ATPC Range
The Min Value and Max Value, for Tx Range in the Atpc management, are shown in the ”Atpc Range”area. The min and max level can be changed by writing the new value in the field.
When the ”Apply” button is pressed the new values will be applied.
2–5.4.5 ATPC Rx Threshold
The value of the power low threshold can be changed by writing the new value in the field.
When the “Apply” button is pressed the new values will be applied.
2–5.5 Power Measurement
The Power Measurements capability is performed through the “Power Meas” tabbed panel in the resourcedetail view (Fig. 88. on page 147).
Fig. 88. Power Measurements
The Measurement screen allows the operator to set initial parameters for the required measurement.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
148
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
“Measurement interval” fields allow the operator to set the time–duration of the measurement. Thedefault is Days: 7, Hours: 0, Minutes: 0. A 7–day measurement interval is also the maximum allowedinterval.
“Sample time” field is the period between two consecutive measurement samples. The choice is among2, 6, 30, 60 sec.
The last section of the dialog is referred to an optional Log file.
By selecting Create File the log file is created and a default path and name for this file is displayed to theoperator. The file is stored in the ALCATEL/CT–Kv3.0.1 directory.
N.B. The file name must not include the following characters: \ ? : * “ < > |.
The log file contains the sample value and records the measurement up to a maximum dimension ( 7 daysfor a 2 s sample time).
By clicking on the ”Start“ button the screen “ Power Measurement Graphic “ appears (see Fig. 97. onpage 157).
The Power Measurement Graphic is available only if the CT is connected to the NE.
The screen in Fig. 89. shows the Tx and Rx measurements related to the local NE.
Through this screen the operator can see, in real time, the power transmitted by the local and remotetransmitter (Tx) and the power received by the local and remote receiver (Rx).
The top graphic screen area shows the TX curves (local and remote), while the bottom area shows theRx curves (local and remote). Note that the colors represent the linked end–point of the two NE; forexample, if the local TX is blue, the remote receiver will also have the same color.
The top of the screen offers all the characteristics present in the current measurement:
– Radio port: gives the symbolic name associated to the radio channel being analized;
– Sample time: indicates the frequency used to send the measurement requests to NE;
– Start time: is the first request time;
– Stop time: is the interval time selected in the previous parameters window, added to the start time;
– Time: is the current response time;
– Log File: is the complete pathname of the file where the received values are stored.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
149
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 89. Power Measurement Graphic
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
150
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
By clicking on “Show details” box, on the left side of the Power Measurement Graphic (see Fig. 89. onpage 149), a new table appears (Fig. 90. on page 150); this table shows the following relevant values ofthe received and transmitted power:
– Tx Local End• max TX local value and date when this value was received for the first time.• min. TX local value and its current date when this value was received for the first time.• current TX local value and its current date.
– Tx Far End• max TX remote value and date when this value was received for the first time.• min. TX remote value and its current date when this value was received for the first time.• current TX remote value and its current date.
– Rx Local End• max Rx local value and date when this value was received for the first time.• min. Rx local value and its current date when this value was received for the first time.• current Rx local value and its current date.
– Rx Far End• max Rx remote value and date when this value was received for the first time.• min. Rx remote value and its current date when this value was received for the first time.• current Rx remote value and its current date.
N.B. PTx and PRx levels software readings tolerance is:– PTx = Real Value ± 3dB– PRx = Real Value ± 5dB
Fig. 90. Power Meas Details
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
151
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–5.5.1 How to read a Power Measurement file
Click on Read File field and press on the Select File button. The directory of the CT automatically opensto navigate and get the power measurement file.
N.B. as default, the measurement files are stored in the ALCATEL/CT–Kv3.0.1 directory and haveextension .txt.
Fig. 91. Name of File ( Log File ) selected screen
Select the desired file and click the Start button in Fig. 88. on page 147 to open the file.
Fig. 92. Example of “Power Measurement File Reading“
The button in the lower part of the window allow to flow the graph within the measurement interval.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
152
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Select the .txt file and click with the mouse right push–button to open .txt file with a text editor (e.g.WordPad) and to see the power information in tabular mode (see Fig. 93. on page 152).
Fig. 93. Example of Power Measurement File Reading (with WordPad)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
153
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–6 FSO
N.B. This menu is available in V.1.0.1 and V.1.0.2 only.
The FSO domain view allows the user to manage the resources of the FSO transmission channel.
This domain view consists of the following areas:
– Resource Tree Area: displays the FSO port.
– Resource List Area: displays tabular information about the selected resource in tree area.
– Resource Detail Area: dislpays, through tabbed windows, the object’ s properties selected in thelist area. This area enables to execute the available functions for involved resource.
In the Resource Tree Area the following objects can be selected:
– Channel#1 refer to para. 2–6.1 on page 154
– FSO Port#1 – Ch#1 refer to para. 2–6.2 on page 155
– Laser#1 or Laser#2 refer to para. 2–6.3 on page 161
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
154
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–6.1 Channel#1
By selecting the Channel 1 object in the Resource Tree Area the screen in Fig. 94. on page 154 appears:
Fig. 94. FSO Domain View
In the Resource List Area is shown the following information:
– Type Interface: the type of the interface (FSO Port only)
– Port number: the number of the port (port 1 only)
– Channel number: the number of the channel (channel 1 only)
– Heater status: the status of the heater installed inside the FSO ODU (Off/On). To activate the Heaterselect FSO Port#1 – Ch#1 in the Resource Tree Area and select Configuration in the ResourceDetail Area.
– Rx Power: the power of the received signal in dBm
– Temperature: the internal temperature inside the FSO ODU measured by an internal temperaturesensor.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
155
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–6.2 FSO Port#1 – Ch#1
By selecting the FSO Port#1 – Ch#1 object in the Resource Tree Area the screen in Fig. 95. on page 155appears.
Fig. 95. FSO port configuration
In the Resource List Area is shown the following information:
– Type Interface: the type of the interface (FSO Port only)
– Port number: the number of the port (port 1 only)
– Channel number: the number of the channel (channel 1 only)
– Laser Index: the identification number of the 2 Lasers installed in the FSO ODU.
– Laser Status: the status of the Laser (On/Off). To switch on or off a Laser select the Laser object inthe Resource Tree Area and select Configuration in the relevant Resource Detail Area.
Three tab panels are present in the Resourse Detail Area:
– Alarms: shows the active alarms (refer to para. 2–6.2.1 on page 156)
– Configuration: configures some FSO parameters (refer to para. 2–6.2.2 on page 156)
– Power Meas: performs the Tx and Rx power measurements (refer to para. 2–6.2.3 on page 156).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
156
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–6.2.1 Alarm
The fault mangement allows to check the current state of alarms related to the selected object.
It is provided by the alarm panel like that shown in para. 2–3.3.1 on page 134.
2–6.2.2 Configuration
The window shown in Fig. 95. on page 155 performs all the available functions for the FSO port.To define the involved port, first select the port/channel in the tabular view: this selection enables the“Resource Detail list” to show the available functions for the resource.
2–6.2.3 Measurements
The Measurement screen (see Fig. 96. on page 156) allows the operator to set initial parameters for therequired measurement.
“Measurement interval” fields allow the operator to set the time duration of the measurement. Thedefault is Days:7, Hours: 0, Minutes: 0. A 7–day measurement interval is also the maximum allowedinterval.
“Sample time” field is the period between two consecutive measurement samples. The choice is among2, 6, 30, 60 sec.
The last section of the dialog is referred to an optional Log file.
By selecting Create File the log file is created and a default path and name for this file is displayed to theoperator. The file is stored in the ALCATEL/CT–Kv3.0.1 directory.
N.B. The file name must not include the following characters: \ ? : * “ < > |.
The log file contains the sample value and records the measurement up to a maximum dimension ( 7 daysfor a 2 s sample time).
Fig. 96. Measurements screen
By clicking on the ”Start“ button the screen “Power Measurement Graphic“ appears (see Fig. 97. onpage 157).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
157
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 97. Power Measurement Graphic Screen
The Power Measurement Graphic is available only if the CT is connected to NE.
The screen in Fig. 97. on page 157 shows the current Rx measurement and the ODU alarms related tothe local NE.
The top graphic screen area shows the Rx curve, while the bottom area shows the alarms active in theODU. The alarms have different colors according to their severity.
The top of the screen offers all the characteristics present in the current measurement:
– FSO port: gives the symbolic name associated to the channel that you are analyzing
– Sample time: indicates the frequency used to send the measurement requests to NE;
– Start time: is the first request time;
– Stop time: is the interval time selected in the previous parameters window, added to the start time;
– Time: is the current response time;
– Log File: is the complete pathname of the file where the received values are stored.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
158
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
By clicking on “Show details” box, on the left side of the Power Measurement Graphic (see Fig. 97. onpage 157), a new table appears (Fig. 98. on page 158); this table shows the following relevant values ofthe received and transmitted power:
– Rx Local End
• max Rx local value and date when this value was received for the first time.
• min. Rx local value and its current date when this value was received for the first time.
• current Rx local value and its current date.
Fig. 98. Details Dialog screen
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
159
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–6.2.3.1 How to read a Power Measurement file
Click on Read File field and press on the Select File button. The directory of the CT automatically opensto navigate and get the power measurement file.
N.B. as default the measurement files are stored in the ALCATEL/CT–Kv3.0.1 directory and haveextension .txt.
Fig. 99. Name of File ( Log File ) selected screen
Select the desired file and click the Start button in Fig. 96. on page 156 to open the file.
Fig. 100. Example of “Power Measurement File Reading“
The button in the lower part of the window allow to flow the graph within the measurement interval.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
160
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Select the .txt file and click with the mouse right push–button to open .txt file with a text editor (e.g.WordPad) and to see the power information in tabular mode (see Fig. 101. on page 160).
Fig. 101. Example of Power Measurement File Reading (with WordPad)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
161
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–6.3 Laser#1 or Laser#2
By selecting the Laser object in the Resource Tree Area the screen in Fig. 102. on page 161 appears.
Fig. 102. FSO laser configuration
In the Resource List Area is shown the following information:
– Type Interface: the type of the interface (FSO Port only)
– Port number: the number of the port (port 1 only)
– Channel number: the number of the channel (channel 1 only)
– Laser Index: the identification number of the 2 Lasers installed in the FSO ODU.
– Laser Status: the status of the Laser (On/Off). To switch on or off a Laser select Configuration inthe relevant Resource Detail Area.In the Laser status field 4 options are available:
• On: the selected Laser is switched ON• Off: the selected Laser is switched OFF• On All: both Lasers (1 and 2) are switched ON• Off All: both Lasers (1 and 2) are switched OFF
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
162
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
163
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–7 EXTERNAL POINTS
This chapter describes the types of functions offered to the user for External Points Management.There are two types of external points: input and output external points.
By clicking on the tree root, displayed in Fig. 103. on page 163, the tree will be expanded according to theequipment configuration.A single left click selection of a tree element causes the activation of the corresponding Tabularrepresentation displayed in the ”Resource list area”. A click on a row in the Resourse list area opens theConfiguration menu in the Resourse Detail Area. An example of this mechanism is diplayed in theFig. 103. on page 163.
2–7.1 Input External Points
An input external point is described by the following parameters (Fig. 103. on page 163):
– Id: identification number– UserLabel: associates a user–friendly name to an external point– Polarity: describes the polarity (Active Closed/ Active Opened)– External State: describes the state (on /off)– Alarm Profile: describes the associated Alarm Profile
The lower part provides the possible parameters, which can be modified; after a row selection, the usercan modify the User Label, the Polarity and can associate a different Alarm Profile by clicking on theSelection button.The operator choices will be sent to NE after selecting the “Apply” button.
Fig. 103. Input External Point View
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
164
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–7.2 Output External Points (in V.1.0.0)
An output external point is described by the following parameters (Fig. 104. on page 164):
– Id: identification number
– UserLabel: associate a user–friendly name to an external point
– Polarity: describes the polarity (Active Closed/ Active Opened)
– External State: describes the state (on /off)
The lower part provides the possible parameters which can be modified; after a row selection, the usercan modify the User Label, Polarity and External State of the external point selected (On=active; Off=notactive).
The operator choices will be sent to NE by clicking on the “Apply” button.
Fig. 104. Output External Points View
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
165
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–7.3 Output External Points (in V.1.0.1 and V.1.0.2)
Seven output external points are available (Fig. 105. on page 165):
The first four external points (CPO#1, 2, 3, 4) are described by the following parameters:
– Id: identification number– UserLabel: a user–friendly name can be associated to an external point– Polarity: describes the polarity (Active Closed/ Active Opened). In this field the polarity of the external
point can be changed.– External State: describes the state (on /off). In this field the external point can be activated (on) or
deactivated (off).
The operator choices will be sent to NE by clicking on the “Apply” button.
The last three external points (FAIL IDU, FAIL ODU Ch.#1, FAIL ODU Ch.#0) are described by thefollowing parameters:
– Id: identification number– UserLabel: a user–friendly name can be associated to an external point– Polarity: describes the polarity (Active Closed/ Active Opened). In this field the polarity of the external
point can be changed.
N.B. These three output external points are automatically activated when the relevant equipmentsummarizing alarm is active.
The operator choices will be sent to NE by clicking on the “Apply” button.
Fig. 105. Output External Points View
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
166
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
N.B. It’s not possible to associate an output with an internal alarm,while is possibile to associate a “Profile alarm” on each input.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
167
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–8 SUPERVISION
2–8.1 Access state (allow or inhibit NE Craft access)
The NE can be managed by the OS or by the Craft Terminal. To control the competition of the OS and theCT, a Local Access Control (LAC) is available.
If the LAC is ”access denied”, it means that the OS manages the NE and the CT is not allowed to modifythe NE configuration (it can only “read”). In the view, the icon with a key symbol has a circular shape.
If the LAC is “granted”, it means that the CT is allowed to manage the NE. In the view, the icon with a keysymbol has a rectangular shape.
If the LAC is ”requested”, it means that the CT has requested a permission from the OS and is waiting fora replay.
However, the OS does continue to provide a certain number of services. These services include:
– Alarm reception and processing,
– Performance processing,
– Switching back to the OS access state.
The access state of an NE can be modified from two types of views:
2–8.1.1 Switching from the OS to the Craft Terminal access state
Select the Supervision pull down menu. Then select the Requested option from the Access Statecascading menu as shown in the following figure.
Fig. 106. Configuration of the Craft access state from the Equipment NE view in the OS mode
From the confirmation dialogue box that opens, you can confirm or cancel the ”Craft access” operationusing the Yes or No pushbutton. The request is sent up to the OS which accepts or refuses it.If the OS doesn’t answer in a predefined time, it is assumed that the NE is in the Craft access stateand can be managed by a Craft Terminal.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
168
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–8.1.2 Switching from the Craft Terminal access state back to the OS access state
Select the Supervision pull down menu. Then from the Access State cascading menu in Fig. 135. onpage 197, select the OS option.From the confirmation dialogue box that opens, you can confirm or cancel the ”OS access” operation.The NE is now managed by the OS.
N.B. The key symbol icon on the management states of the NE view indicates whether the NE ismanaged by a craft terminal or by the OS.
N.B. Local Craft Terminal access is denied on recovery phase after a loss of communication of theNE. When the communication with the NE is lost, the OS automatically recovers thecommunication and forces the state existing before the loss of communication (therefore, CraftTerminal access can be denied or granted).
2–8.2 Restart NE
The RESTART operation is a software reset and can be executed in normal traffic conditions.
From the Supervision cascading menu, select the Restart NE option.
Fig. 107. Restart NE call
The following dialogue box opens.
Fig. 108. Restart NE confirmation
Click the OK button to confirm the restart N.E. operation
Click the Cancel button to abort the restart N.E. operation.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
169
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–8.3 SW key
From the Supervision cascading menu, select the SW key option.
In this screen the type of the key (stored in the flash card installed in the Main IDU unit) is shown.
Fig. 109. SW key screen
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
170
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
171
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–9 PROTECTION SCHEMES
N.B. This menu is available in V.1.0.1 and V.1.0.2 only for the Radio application.
This domain is present in 1+1 configuration.
This domain view consists of the following areas (Fig. 110. on page 171):
– Resource Tree Area: displays the radio ports sorted by channel number.
– Resource List Area: displays tabular informations about the selected resource in tree area.
– Resource Detail Area: displays, through tabbed windows, the properties done in list area. This areaenable to perform the available functions for involved resource.
By clicking on the tree root displayed in Fig. 110. on page 171, the tree will be expanded according toprotection schemes supported.
Fig. 110. Protection Schemes
A single left click selection of an element tree causes the activation of the corresponding Graphicalrepresentation displayed in the “Resource list area”. An exemple of this mechanism is displayed in thefollowing figure (Fig. 111. on page 172).
Three 1+1 protection schemes have been implemented:
– Mux protection: EPS protection in Tx side– Radio protection: EPS protection in Rx side– HST protection: Hot Stand–by protection
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
172
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
To see the current position of the switches enter the menu Diagnosis –> Summary Block Diagram View(refer to para. 2–11.4 on page 196).
– The Mux protection corresponds to the Switch Tx in Fig. 137. on page 199 or Fig. 138. on page 200
– The Radio protection corresponds to the Switch Rx in Fig. 137. on page 199 or Fig. 138. on page200
– The HST protection is implemented in the ODU: one Transmitter is connected to the antenna(active), the other transmitter is in stand–by. Refer to Fig. 137. on page 199.
2–9.1 Mux Protection Management
The Equipment Protection Management is performed by selecting Mux Protection tree element.
The following windows (Fig. 111. on page 172) allows a complete view of all Ne resource involved in theEPS protection:
– Schema Parameters
– Channels Parameters
Fig. 111. Mux Protection
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
173
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–9.1.1 Schema Parameters
The window “Schema Parameters” displays the parameters that can be modify.
The Schema parameters are:
– Protection Type: this parameter is defined at creation time and it is read only. The supported typeis: 1+1, e.g. a working channel (Main) is protected by a protecting channel (Spare).
– Operation type: it defines if automatic restoration from protecting to protected channel is allowed(revertive mode) or inhibited (not revertive mode).
The operator choice for “Operation Type” will be applied by clicking on “Apply” button.
2–9.1.2 Commands
To enter the Commands menu click on the Spare #0 element in the Tree view (Fig. 112. on page 173)or on the Main #1 element (Fig. 113. on page 174).
Fig. 112. Mux Protection Switch (Spare #0)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
174
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 113. Mux Protection Switch (Main #1)
The operator by the Craft Terminal can modify the state of the switch through commands Lockout, Forcedand Manual.
Lockout has higher priority than Forced: the activation forces in service Channel 1 (default channel),independently of the possible active alarms. This command activates signaling ABN.
Forced has higher priority than the automatic operation: the activation of this command forces in serviceChannel 0, independently of the possible active alarms. This command activates signaling ABN.
Automatic Switch is the normal operation condition: the position of the switch depends on the commandsgenerated by the logic.
Manual has the lowest priority: it is performed only if there are no alarms that can activate an automaticswitch. It cannot be performed if Lockout or Forced commands are already activated. If this command isactive, it will be removed by an incoming alarm. This command does not activate signaling ABN.
Tab. 5. Command priority list
Command Priority
Lockout 1
Forced 2
Automatic switch 3
Manual 4
N.B. to release a previously activated command select None and click on Apply.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
175
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–9.2 Radio Protection Management
The Radio Protection Management is performed selecting Radio Protection element tree.
The following windows (Fig. 114. on page 175) allows a complete view of all Ne resource involved in a RPSprotection:
– Schema Parameters
– Channels Parameters
Fig. 114. Radio Protection View
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
176
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–9.2.1 Schema Parameter
The window “Schema Parameters” displays the parameters that can be modify.
The Schema Parameters are:
– ”Protection Type” field: defines the protection schema architecture: 1+1;
– ”Operation Type” field: the possible values are revertive (automatic restoration allowed) ornotRevertive (automatic restoration Inhibited).
2–9.2.2 Commands
To enter the Commands menu click on the Spare #0 element in the Tree view (Fig. 115. on page 176)or on the Main #1 element (Fig. 116. on page 177).
Fig. 115. Radio Protection Switch (Spare #0)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
177
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 116. Radio Protection Switch (Main #1)
The operator by the Craft Terminal can modify the state of the switch through commands Lockout, Forcedand Manual.
Lockout has higher priority than Forced: the activation forces in service Channel 1 (default channel),independently of the possible active alarms. This command activates signaling ABN.
Forced has higher priority than the automatic operation: the activation of this command forces in serviceChannel 0, independently of the possible active alarms. This command activates signaling ABN.
Automatic Switch is the normal operation condition: the position of the switch depends on the commandsgenerated by the logic.
Manual has the lowest priority: it is performed only if there are no alarms that can activate an automaticswitch. It cannot be performed if Lockout or Forced commands are already activated. If this command isactive, it will be removed by an incoming alarm. This command does not activate signaling ABN.
Tab. 6. Command priority list
Command Priority
Lockout 1
Forced 2
Automatic switch 3
Manual 4
N.B. to release a previously activated command select None and click on Apply.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
178
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–9.3 HST Transmission Protection Management
The Transmission Protection Management is performed selecting Transmission Protection element tree.
The following windows (Fig. 117. on page 178) allows a complete view of all Ne resource involved in a TPSprotection:
– Schema Parameters
– Channels Parameters
Fig. 117. Transmission Protection View
2–9.3.1 Schema Parameters
The window “Schema Parameters” displays the parameters that can be modify.
The Schema parameters are:
– Protection Type: this parameter is defined at creation time and it is read only. The supported typeare: 1+1 (onePlusOne) ,e.g. a working element is protected by one protecting unit.
– Operation type: it defines if automatic restoration from protecting to protected unit is allowed(revertive mode) or inhibited (not revertive mode).
The operator choice for “Operation Type” will be applied clicking on “Apply” button.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
179
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–9.3.2 Commands
To enter the Commands menu click on the Spare #0 element (Fig. 118. on page 179) or on the Main #1element (Fig. 119. on page 180) in the Tree view.
Fig. 118. Tx Protection Commands (Spare #0)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
180
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 119. Tx Protection Commands (Main #1)
The operator by the Craft Terminal can modify the state of the switch through commands Lockout, Forcedand Manual.
Lockout has higher priority than Forced: the activation connects to the antenna Transmitter 1 (defaulttransmitter), independently of the possible active alarms. This command activates signaling ABN.
Forced has higher priority than the automatic operation: the activation of this command connects to theantenna Transmitter 0, independently of the possible active alarms. This command activates signalingABN.
Automatic Switch is the normal operation condition: the position of the switch depends on the commandsgenerated by the logic.
Manual has the lowest priority: it is performed only if there are no alarms that can activate an automaticswitch. It cannot be performed if Lockout or Forced commands are already activated. If this command isactive, it will be removed by an incoming alarm. This command does not activate signaling ABN.
Tab. 7. Command priority list
Command Priority
Lockout 1
Forced 2
Automatic switch 3
Manual 4
N.B. to release a previously activated command select None and click on Apply.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
181
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–10 LOOPBACKS
The functions described in this section allow to perform the test operations.
This domain view consists of the following areas:
– Resource Tree Area: displays the object on which the loopbacks can be performed, sorted bynumber.
– Resource Filter Area: display the possible filters to apply to loopback search.
– Resource List Area: displays tabular information about the loopback supported by the resourceselected in tree area.
– Resource Detail Area: displays, through tabbed windows, the properties done in list area. This areaenable to perform the available functions for involved resource.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
182
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–10.1 Available Loopbacks
N.B. Tab. 8. shows the loopbacks performed on the local NE, which activation does not cause theloss of the supervision (UP) of the remote NE and the loopbacks, which activation will causethe loss of the supervision (DOWN) of the remote NE.
Tab. 8. Loopbacks on the local NE
CH MAIN (1+0) system
TRIBUTARIES UP for nxE1/DS1; DOWN for E3/DS3
IDU–CABLE DOWN
ODU–CABLE DOWN
R.F. DOWN
TRIB. FE UP
TRIB. NE UP
CH SPARE (1+1) system with Spare lock–out
TRIBUTARIES UP for nxE1/DS1; DOWN for E3/DS3
IDU–CABLE UP
ODU–CABLE UP
R.F. UP
TRIB. FE UP
TRIB. NE UP
CH MAIN (1+1) system with Spare lock–out
TRIBUTARIES UP for nxE1/DS1; DOWN for E3/DS3
IDU–CABLE DOWN
ODU–CABLE DOWN
R.F. DOWN
TRIB. FE UP
TRIB. NE UP
CH SPARE (1+1) system with Main forced
TRIBUTARIES UP for nxE1/DS1; DOWN for E3/DS3
IDU–CABLE DOWN
ODU–CABLE DOWN
R.F. DOWN
TRIB. FE UP
TRIB. NE UP
CH MAIN (1+1) system with Main forced
TRIBUTARIES UP for nxE1/DS1; DOWN for E3/DS3
IDU–CABLE UP
ODU–CABLE UP
R.F. UP
TRIB. FE UP
TRIB. NE UP
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
183
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–10.1.1 1+0 FSO Loopbacks
TRIB MODEMMUX/DEMUX
OPT.TxRx
21 4 5 7
MODEM TRIB
3
IDU FSO ODU FSO ODU IDU
CT
MUX/DEMUX
6
OPT.TxRx
Fig. 120. 1+0 FSO available loopbacks
Tab. 9. 1+0 FSO loopbacks
No.Loopback
name
CT selection inthe Resourse
Tree Area
Ref. toFig.
LocationLoopback
typeNote
1E1/DS1Port#xx
TributariesFig. 122. Fig. 123.
Near End External lineInput loopback attributary level
2E1/DS1Port#xx
Channel 1Fig. 121. Fig. 123.
Near End External line
Loopback toward theremote station attributary level. Thisloopback can beactivated in the localstation only.
3E1/DS1Port#xx
Channel 1 Fig. 121. Far End InternalLoopback in theremote station attributary level
4 IDU cable Channel 1Fig. 121. Fig. 123.
Near End InternalLoopback at the IDUoutput at aggregatelevel
5ODU FSO
cableChannel 1
Fig. 121. Fig. 123.
Near End InternalLoopback at the ODUinput at aggregatelevel
6ODU FSO
IF #1Channel 1
Fig. 121. Fig. 123.
Near End Internal IF
Loopback betweenthe Modulator outputand Demodulatorinput
7ODU FSO
opticalChannel 1
Fig. 121. Fig. 123.
Near End InternalOptical loopback atthe ODU level
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
184
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 121. Channel 1 Loopback View
Fig. 122. Tributaries Loopback View
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
185
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
In the Resource List Area are listed all the loopbacks which can be performed.
In this area the following information is given:
– Channel: the number of the channel (channel 1 only)
– Type Interface: the type of interface in which a loopback can be performed.
– Location: the station in which the loopback is performed (Near End/Far End)
– Type: the type of the loopback (Internal/Internal IF/External Line)
– Modality: the type of the loopback (Loop and Continue only)
– Activation: the activation status of a loopback (Active/Not Active)
In Fig. 123. on page 185 is given the association of all the possible loopbacks and their positions in theblock diagram of the equipment provided by the Summary Block Diagram View option, available in theDiagnosis menu.
Tributaries(External Line)
ODU FSOCABLE
ODU FSOOptical
ODU FSOIF#1
IDUCABLE
Channel(External Line)
1
2
5 7
64
Fig. 123. 1+0 FSO Loopback types
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
186
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–10.1.2 1+0 Radio Loopbacks
TRIB MODEMMUX/DEMUX
RF
21 4 5 6
MODEMRF TRIB
3
IDU ODU ODU IDU
CT
MUX/DEMUX
Fig. 124. 1+0 Radio available loopbacks
Tab. 10. 1+0 Radio loopbacks
No.Loopback
name
CT selection inthe Resourse
Tree Area
Ref. toFig.
LocationLoopback
typeNote
1E1/DS1Port#xx
TributariesFig. 126. Fig. 127.
Near End External lineInput loopback attributary level
2E1/DS1Port#xx
Channel 1Fig. 125. Fig. 127.
Near End External line
Loopback toward theremote station attributary level. Thisloopback can beactivated in the localstation only.
3E1/DS1Port#xx
Channel 1 Fig. 125. Far End InternalLoopback in theremote station attributary level
4 IDU cable Channel 1Fig. 125. Fig. 127.
Near End InternalLoopback at the IDUoutput at aggregatelevel
5 ODU cable Channel 1Fig. 125. Fig. 127.
Near End InternalLoopback at the ODUinput at aggregatelevel
6 Radio port Channel 1Fig. 125. Fig. 127.
Near End InternalRF local loopback(Note 1)
Note 1: Before activating this loopback the Remote Tx must be muted (Menu Radio –> Configuration)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
187
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 125. Channel 1 Loopback View
Fig. 126. Tributaries Loopback View
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
188
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
In the Resource List Area are listed all the loopbacks which can be performed.
In this area the following information is given:
– Channel: the number of the channel (channel 1 only)
– Type Interface: the type of interface in which a loopback can be performed.
– Location: the station in which the loopback is performed (Near End/Far End)
– Type: the type of the loopback (Internal/Internal IF/External Line)
– Modality: the type of the loopback (Loop and Continue only)
– Activation: the activation status of a loopback (Active/Not Active)
In Fig. 127. on page 188 is given the association of all the possible loopbacks and their positions in theblock diagram of the equipment provided by the Summary Block Diagram View option, available in theDiagnosis menu.
Tributaries(External Line)
ODUCABLE
Radioport
(RF loop)
IDUCABLE
Channel(External Line)
1
2
5 6
4
Fig. 127. 1+0 Radio Loopback types
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
189
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–10.1.3 1+1 Radio Loopbacks
TRIB MODEMMUX/DEMUX
RF
21 4 5 6
MODEMRF TRIB
3
IDU ODU ODU IDU
CT
MUX/DEMUX
Fig. 128. 1+1 Radio available loopbacks
Tab. 11. 1+1 Radio loopbacks
No.Loopback
name
CT selection inthe Resourse
Tree Area
Ref. toFig.
LocationLoopback
typeNote
1E1/DS1Port#xx
TributariesFig. 130. Fig. 131.
Near End External lineInput loopback attributary level
2E1/DS1Port#xx
Channel 0 or 1Fig. 129. Fig. 131.
Near End External line
Loopback toward theremote station attributary level. Thisloopback can beactivated in the localstation only.
3E1/DS1Port#xx
Channel 0 or1Fig. 129. Fig. 131.
Far End InternalLoopback in theremote station attributary level
4 IDU cable Channel 0 or 1Fig. 129. Fig. 131.
Near End InternalLoopback at the IDUoutput at aggregatelevel
5 ODU cable Channel 0 or 1Fig. 129. Fig. 131.
Near End InternalLoopback at the ODUinput at aggregatelevel
6 Radio port Channel 0 or 1Fig. 129. Fig. 131.
Near End InternalRF local loopback(Note 1)
Note 1: Before activating this loopback the Remote Tx must be muted (Menu Radio –> Configuration).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
190
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 129. Channel 1 Loopback View
Fig. 130. Tributaries Loopback View
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
191
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
In the Resource List Area are listed all the loopbacks which can be performed.
In this area the following information is given:
– Channel: the number of the channel (channel 1 only)
– Type Interface: the type of interface in which a loopback can be performed.
– Location: the station in which the loopback is performed (Near End/Far End)
– Type: the type of the loopback (Internal/Internal IF/External Line)
– Modality: the type of the loopback (Loop and Continue only)
– Activation: the activation status of a loopback (Active/Not Active)
In Fig. 131. on page 191 is given the association of all the possible loopbacks and their positions in theblock diagram of the equipment provided by the Summary Block Diagram View option, available in theDiagnosis menu.
Tributaries(External Line)
Radio port(RF loop)
IDUCABLE
Channel(External Line)
ODUCABLE
1
2
5 64
Fig. 131. 1+1 Radio Loopback types
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
192
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–10.2 How to activate a loopback
N.B. For the loopbacks under Ch. 0 and Ch.1 option must force/lockout all switches to relatedChannel; for the loopbacks Tributaries > DSx port#y must only force the radio switch Channel0 or lockout to Channel 1 independently.
To activate a loopback:
[1] Select the loopback to be activated inside of the of the loopback screen in the USM as shown inFig. 132. on page 192.
[2] Once the loopback is selected click ACTIVE in the configuration menu and APPLY.
[3] The Loopback is now ACTIVE.
Fig. 132. Loopback activation
WARNING:
When the Loopback commands start the Craft Terminal is not “frozen”. Before to set another commandis recommended to wait 120 to 160 seconds minimun.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
193
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–10.3 How to remove a loopback
To deactivate loopbacks use the folllowing steps:
[1] Select the loopback to be deactivated inside of the loopback screen in the Fig. 133. on page 193.
[2] Once the loopback is selected clik NOT ACTIVE in the configuration menu and APPLY.
[3] The loopback is now deactivated.
N.B. If a force or lockout command was used during the activation, ensure that the command isremoved after the test.
Fig. 133. Loopback removing
WARNING:
When the Loopback commands start the Craft Terminal is not “frozen”. Before to set another commandis recommended to wait 120 to 160 seconds minimun.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
194
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
195
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–11 DIAGNOSIS
In the Diagnosis menu four options are available as shown in Fig. 134.
Fig. 134. Diagnosis menu
2–11.1 Log Browsing
In the Diagnosis pull–down menu, select the Log Browsing option.
The proposed options:
– Select the Alarm Log option to access the Alarm Log file.
The Alarm Log windows opens, permitting to analyze all the alarms stored in the NE.Refer to the “ELB Operator’s Handbook”.
– Select the Event Log option to access the Event Log file.
The Event Log windows opens, permitting to analyze all the events stored in the NE.Refer to the “ELB Operator’s Handbook”.
– Software Trace Log option is reserved to the Alcatel technicians.
2–11.2 Remote Inventory
This screen is a read–only screen, which shows all the information on the equipment.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
196
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–11.3 Abnormal Condition List
The Abnormal Condition List option in the Diagnosis menu displays all the abnormal conditions (i.e.the manual operations) currently active in the NE.
The abnormal conditions can be:
– Switch commands Forced or Lockout– Loopback– Tx power manual operation– Tx muting (manual or automatic)– ODU service kit connected– FSO laser muting
2–11.4 Summary Block Diagram View
The “Summary Block Diagram View” of the Diagnosis menu displays a global logical view (strictlyrelated to the physical implementation) highlighting a synthesis of all the alarms and statuses present inthe system (ODU+IDU).
This window also shows a logical view of the signal flowing through the functional block and switches.
Line (and arrow) trace changes in compliance with the current switch status. By clicking on the objectsof the drawing shown in the figure the operator can navigate to the specific view to perform maintenanceoperation (for example specific alarm details, equipment details, manual switches, loopback (L),performance monitoring (P).
The Summary Block Diagram View depends on the configuration:
– 1+0 FSO (see Fig. 135. on page 197)– 1+0 Radio (see Fig. 136. on page 198)– 1+1 HST Radio (see Fig. 137. on page 199)– 1+1 FD Radio (see Fig. 138. on page 200)
In detail, it is possible to:
– navigate from Alarm indicator to related “Alarm Synthesis”;– navigate from External Point indicator to “External Point” view;– navigate from Switch indicator to related “Protection Scheme” view;– navigate from Loopback indicator to specific “Loopback” view; for example, by clicking on (L)
indicator of main board (Ch#1) the operator can navigate to loopback view for PDH tributaries;– navigate from Performance indicator to specific “Performance” view; for example, by clicking on
(P) indicator (line side) the operator can navigate to “Current Data” view;– navigate from ODU box to the ”radio view” with automatic selection of the related channel.
To refresh the screen press the Refresh button.
N.B.
• Loopback indicator: yellow letter L means active loop.• Performance indicator: yellow letter P means active performance.
N.B. In the 1+1 configuration the current position of the switches is also shown.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
197
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 135. Summary Block Diagram View: 1+0 FSO
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
198
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 136. Summary Block Diagram View: 1+0 Radio
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
199
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 137. Summary Block Diagram View: 1+1 HST Radio
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
200
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 138. Summary Block Diagram View: 1+1 FD Radio
By pressing the Refresh button the refresh of the screen takes place (active loopback and performanceand position of the switch).
2–11.5 Current Configuration View
This screen is a read–only screen, which shows the current configuration of the NE.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
201
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–12 PERFORMANCE MONITORING
This chapter describes the functions to provide Performance Monitoring management. It explains theprocedures that the operator must perform in order to activate a PM process.
2–12.1 General information on the performance monitoring process
The performance monitoring (PM) gives indication on the quality of the service.Quality of service PM is performed in accordance with G.826 and G.784.It is assumed that the quality of the single tributary (E1, T1, …) can be derived from the quality of theaggregate signal, therefore no dedicated quality of service PM is foreseen on the single tributaries.Considering one section (see below), one current register is for 15 min report and one for 24 h report; 96history data can be stored for 15 min report and 8 history data for 24 h report.
N.B. The 15 min Performance Monitoring data are stored in the History Data report only if errorshave been occurred.The 24 h Performance Monitoring data are always stored in the History Data report.
The radio section monitored is:
– Radio Hop Section: the section between two radio stations inside the protection section
MODEMRF
MODEMRF
FECDECODE
PROPR.FRAMING
PROPR.FRAMING
FECENCODE
Radio Hop (before the switch)
Fig. 139. Radio section
The counters supported are the following:
– Errored Seconds– Severly Errored Seconds– Background Block Error– Unavailable Seconds
The primitives used for the hop section quality monitoring is the Reed–Solomon (RS) decoder (block size:2040 bits). The following table provides, for each frame structure, the main features useful to define a SES.
Tab. 12. SES Thresholds
E3 16E1 8E1 4E1 2E1 DS3 16DS1 8DS1 4DS1
Gross bit rate[MHz]
39,168 39,168 19,584 9,792 4,896 57,120 28,560 14,280 7,140
RS Blocksnumber/sec.
19200 19200 9600 4800 2400 28000 14000 7000 3500
SES Threshold(Note 1)
5760 5760 2880 1440 720 8400 4200 2100 1050
(Note 1) Note that according to ITU–T G.826 a second is declared Severely Errored Second if it is asecond period with more than 30 % of errored blocks or at least one defect.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
202
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
The flow chart shown below illustrates the recognition of anomalies, defects, errored blocks, ES and SESaccording to ITU–T G.826 (12/2002).
T1313790–98
Monitoredsecond
YesDefects?
No
Anomalies?
N
%EB≥ 30?
ES(but not a SES)
Path inavailable
State?
cES = cES + 1
Path inavailable
State?
cBBE = cBBE + EB(s) cSES = cSES + 1
End
cES = cES + 1
SES(and therefore an ES)
No
Yes
Yes
No
No
Yes Yes
Fig. 140. Anomalies, defects, errored blocks, ES and SES according to ITU–T G.826
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
203
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–12.2 Performance menu
The performance view allows the user to activate and monitor the PM process on the selected object.
This domain view consists of the following areas (Fig. 141. on page 203):
– Resource Tree Area: displays the threshold for measurement and the object monitoring sorted bychannel number.
– Resource List Area: displays the PM management for the selected resource in the tree area.
Fig. 141. Performance View
The performance reports can be of 2 different types:
– 15 minutes
– 24 hours
The following description explains the functions to provide the PM process with a granularity period of 15min. The same functions are provided for 24h PM process.
The PM are only of HOP type. The current report can be seen (and configured) and the history PM logcan be seen.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
204
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
With reference to Fig. 141. on page 203 to see (and configure) the current report:
[1] click on the channel (0 or 1) (in 1+0 configuration channel 1 only)
[2] click on HOP
[3] click on the desired granularity (15 m or 24 h)
[4] click on CD (Current Data).
With reference to Fig. 141. on page 203 to see an history log:
[1] click on the channel (0 or 1) (in 1+0 configuration channel 1 only)
[2] click on HOP
[3] click on the desired granularity (15 m or 24 h)
[4] click on the desired HD (History Data).
To each PM can be associated a threshold table. To associate a threshold table click on HOP in theResourse Tree Area. The screen in Fig. 142. will appear.
Fig. 142. Threshold table association screen
In this screen the threshold (1 or 2) and an Alarm Profile can be associated to the report.
To associate an Alarm Profile click on the selection box and selet one of the Alarm Profiles available.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
205
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–12.3 CD (Current Data)
The window displayed in Fig. 143. on page 205 allows to start and to read the 15min PM report and 24hPM report.
Fig. 143. Current Data View
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
206
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–12.3.1 CD parameters
The fields displayed in the upper part of Fig. 143. on page 205 allow the operator to check and managethe parameter of the current data collection.
– “Suspect interval” shows whether the current data are suspect or not.
– “Elapsed Time” field (read–only) displays the elapsed time in the current interval of monitoring.
– “End Period”: display time of the PM in the graphical description and in the tabular description inthe upper part of the screen. By pressing the Refresh button this time changes.
– “Max Interval supp.”: max. number of intervals (reports) which can be suppressed in the Historybecause they don’t have errors.
– “Num. Interval supp.”: number of intervals (reports) suppressed in the History because they don’thave errors.
2–12.3.2 CD Counters
The fields and buttons displayed in the lower part of Fig. 143. on page 205 (Counters Area) allow themanagement of performance events.
In the left part of Counters Area, there is a graphical description of the event counter value: BBE (Erroredblock), ES (Errored second), SES (Severely Errored Second), UAS (Unavailable second).
N.B. these values refer to the last refresh performed by pressing the Refresh button.
In the right part of Fig. 143. on page 205, there are button choice to perform action on the current datacollection:
– “Reset” button resets the data collection and related counters.
– “Start” button starts the counters for the data collection, when the CD has been stopped.
– ”Refresh” button makes a refresh of the counters.
– “Stop” button stops the counters for the data collection, when the CD has been started.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
207
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–12.4 HD (History Data)
The PM process monitors the parameters during a specified interval (i.e. 15min) and stores their valuesin history data. A History Data collection is created automatically at the end of each time interval of CurrentData and deleted when the relative CD is deleted.
2–12.4.1 HD Parameters
The table displayed on the following window (Fig. 144. on page 207) collects the history data for a relatedPM report.
Fig. 144. History Data
The table columns hold the value of following parameters:
– End Period: End period of the relevant report
– Elapsed time: elapsed time in the related interval
– Suspect interval: this field describes whether the History Data is suspect or not.
– Counters: the last columns hold the counters value (BBE, ES, SES, UAS).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
208
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–12.5 Threshold Data
This section describes how to see or change the threshold tables assigned to PM counters.
To view the available threshold for PM process, the operator must select the “Thresholds Tables” nodetree in the Resource Tree Area of the Performance View.
By clicking on the threshold table on the view area the parameters of the 2 tables will appears (Fig. 145. onpage 208).
Fig. 145. Thresholds Tables
By clicking on threshold 1 or 2 in the Resourse List Area the screen in Fig. 146. on page 209 will appear.
In the upper part of Fig. 146. on page 209, the “Name” field displays the name assigned to the thresholdtable.
In the lower part of Fig. 146. on page 209, low and high threshold for each counter is shown. To changethem, the operator must edit the new values in the table fields and click on the “Apply” button.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
209
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Fig. 146. Threshold table configuration
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
210
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
211
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–13 SW DOWNLOAD
2–13.1 Server Access Configuration This menu allows to configure the FTP server to be used to download the SWP to the NE.
N.B. The complete procedure to download the SWP to the NE is shown in para. 1–2.3 on page 60.
Fig. 147. Server access configuration screen
User Id and Password are the login information to access the FTP server.
In the Address field write the IP address of the FTP server.
In the Port field write the port to be used and in the Root Directory field write the directory into which thesoftware has been downloaded.
By clicking on the Use System Default button a screen will appear showing the default configuration.
The CT is the default FTP server with the following parameters:
– User Id: ftp– Password: ftp– Address: IP address of the F interface or IP address of the Ethernet interface, if present.– Port: 15,000
N.B. the System Default can be changed by writing different values in the fields and then by clickingon button OK.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
212
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–13.2 Init SW Download
Through this menu software is downloaded to the NE in order to upgrade the NE software version.
To start download select the desired software version and click on the Init download button.
N.B. This screen displays the software packages previously stored through the menu Supervision–> Files Administration –> Software Administration available in the NES menu.
The Forced check box can be used to force download (i.e. the complete description file is downloadedto the NE).
If the Forced download is not selected, the system shall first proceed to compare the software to bedownloaded with the software present in the NE. Then only the differences are downloaded.
Fig. 148. Init Software Download screen
When the SW download starts a screen, showing the in progress operation of the download, appears.Download is aborted when the Abort button is pressed.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
213
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2–13.3 SW Status
This menu allows to display the information of the software installed in the NE.
The following information is displayed:
– Name: software name
– Version: software version
– Operational state: enabled or disabled
– Current status: committed or standby
By clicking on the Software Units Status button the screen of Fig. 149. on page 213 opens, givingadditional information on the software package.
Fig. 149. SW Status screen
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
214
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
The following information is displayed on the screen:
– EC: software on the Equipment Controller
– OC_R: software on the ODU Controller (Radio)
– OC_F: software on the ODU Controller (FSO)
Fig. 150. SW Unit Status screen
The Flash card, which stores the NE software, contains 2 banks.
The 2 banks can store 2 different software versions. One bank will be committed (active) and the otherbank will be standby.
N.B. The second bank will appear when a new software package has been downloaded the first time.
During download, necessary to update the software version, the download file is automatically stored inthe standby bank.
To activate the new version first check the operational status of the standby bank. If the status is enabled(this means that download took place without errors) select Activation or Forced Activation in theSoftware Management Action field and click on the Apply Action button.
By selecting Forced Activation the bank to be activated is forced to restart.
By selecting Activation the bank to be activated restarts only if the content of the two banks differ.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
215
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
SECTION 3: AWY/FSO MAINTENANCE
SECTION CONTENT PAGE
Chapter 3–1 – Maintenance introduction 216
Chapter 3–2 – Troubleshooting 217
The symbol points out references to Other Handbooks.
Referenced handbook P/Ns are given in para.E.2 on page 279 of this handbook.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
216
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
3–1 MAINTENANCE INTRODUCTION
This section is the 9400AWY/FSO Maintenance Manual; it describes mainly the NE troubleshooting basedon the use of the Craft Terminal.
It applies to 9400AWY SWP Rel.1.0.
The document that should be read before starting this document is:
9400AWY Technical Handbooks, section MAINTENANCEor:
9400FSO Technical Handbooks, section MAINTENANCE
– 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Technical Handbook and 9400FSO R.1.0 Technical Handbook R.1.0.
N.B. In particular, knowing the contents of section “MAINTENANCE” of Technical Handbook isa must.
– 1320CT Basic Operator’s Handbook V.3.0.1
The maintenance procedures consist of the following steps:
– PC Maintenance. See para.3–1.1 herebelow.
– Problems with the Craft Terminal PC (shut–down and restart ). See para.3–1.2 herebelow.
– Corrective Maintenance (Troubleshooting). See Chapter 3–2 on page 217.
3–1.1 Maintenance of the PC
With regard to the PC maintenance, refer to the constructor’s documentation.
3–1.2 Problems with THE Craft Terminal
This procedure describes how to shutdown and restart the PC should the Craft Terminal SoftWare Productnot be working properly or not responding to the operator’s commands.
In order to shutdown the PC execute the command :
Start > Shutdown
A window (Windows NT Security user dialog) is displayed. It permits to shutdown the computer or restartit.
The same window is displayed pressing he keys <Ctrl> + <Alt> + <Del> simultaneously.
N.B. In the case this procedure is unsuccesful, carry out the checks indicated in:
9400AWY or 9400FSO Technical Handbookssection MAINTENANCE,
chapter SECOND LEVEL MAINTENANCEparagraph TROUBLESHOOTING–PROBLEMS WITH THE CRAFT TERMINAL
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
217
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
3–2 TROUBLESHOOTING
3–2.1 Purpose of this procedureTroubleshooting involves detection, location and correction of the failures occurred in the equipment andreplacement of the defective parts.
3–2.2 Corrective Maintenance general flow–chartAs depicted in Fig. 151. herebelow, troubleshooting via Craft Terminal is just a step inside the CorrectiveMaintenance process.
Alarm acknowledgment and attending (para...)
Trouble–Shooting starting with visual indications (para......)
Trouble–Shooting via Craft Terminal.Identification of a unit to be replaced.
Other measures
Unit replacement in the IDU (para...). ODU replacement (para...)
System check via Craft Terminal
Fault repaired ?Try again withanother unit
If possible, restore replaced unit in the system and performsystem check via Craft Terminal, to verify that is really faulty
Y
N
Possible intermittentfailure
Fixed fault ?N
Send back faulty unit to Repair Centre togetherwith Repair Form compiled (para......)
START
END
Restore spare part in the system and performsystem check via Craft Terminal
Y
Fig. 151. Corrective Maintenance general flow–chart
For detailed information regarding the whole Corrective Maintenance procedure, please refer to:
9400AWY or 9400FSO Technical Handbooks, section MAINTENANCEchapter SECOND LEVEL MAINTENANCE, paragraph CORRECTIVE MAINTENANCE
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
218
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
3–2.3 Troubleshooting organization
The troubleshooting procedure is carried out with the help of some tables, reported hereinafter. Anywaythis method does not deal with the following issues (which are to be dealt with otherwise):
– faulty electronic alarm indication, processing and detection circuits
– faulty wiring (back–panel, connectors, etc.)
The following interfaces are present on the equipment for troubleshooting purposes:
• Ethernet interface for the Telecommunication Management Network ( TMN )
• F interface for the Craft Terminal (Local or Remote)
• LEDs located on the NE’s units.
Usually, maintenance is firstly done via software (TMN or Remote Craft Terminal) to locate the faultyequipment and the faulty unit or the faulty path and then on site to physically correct the trouble.
Maintenance can be done:
• from a TMN network management center
• from a Remote Craft Terminal (RCT) management center
• on site.
TMN network management center: by means of the TMN, the maintenance technician can see thealarms generated by each equipment of the managed network (see the relevant TMN handbooks).
Remote craft terminal: the operator, connected to a local NE, can remotely manage and troubleshoota network composed of max 128 NEs, including itself. This handbook applies.
On site : the operator is on site in case :
1 ) the equipment is not managed by a TMN or by a Remote Craft terminal (RCT).
2 ) the equipment is not reachable by the remote manager (TMN or RCT) and therefore is isolated.
3 ) link problems are present.
4 ) the trouble has been located and a physical replacement is necessary.
In cases 1 ) , 2 ), 3 ), the alarmed equipment is checked by means of the local Craft Terminal.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
219
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
The NE is provided with LEDs which indicate:
Centralized Equipment Alarms:
All alarms detected on the units are collected by the MAIN unit, which delivers centralized indications (bymeans of LEDs on the front coverplate). Specifically:
• Red LED: detection of a MAJOR (URGENT) alarm.
• Red LED: detection of a MINOR (NOT URGENT) alarm.
• Yellow LED: alarm condition ATTENDED.
• Red LED: detection of a LDI (problem in the local equipment).
• Red LED: detection of an RDI (problem in the remote equipment).
In the case of a MAJOR or MINOR alarm, after locating the alarmed unit, the alarm condition can be”attended” by pressing the alarm storing push button on the front panel of the MAIN unit.
This condition causes on the front coverplate:
• yellow LED ATTENDED to light up
• red LEDs MINOR and MAJOR to turn off (free to accept other alarms)If both LEDs are on, the Attend command should be given twice : one to attend the MINORalarm and one to attend the MAJOR alarm.
The troubleshooting operation is done by means of the Craft Terminal, and of the optical indicators (LEDs)present on the NE.
The Craft Terminal is connected to the relative connector on the front coverplate (F interface) of the MAINunit.
The Craft Terminal applications provide detailed information on the alarm state thus facilitating faultlocation and subsequent removal as indicated in para. 3–2.4 on page 220.
To correctly execute the troubleshooting operations the technician must know the equipmentconfiguration (see Equipment applications on the Craft Terminal).
The following tables should be also consulted when the unit LEDs flash; as a matter of fact, the flashingcondition might be due to external alarm causes usually, related to line problems.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
220
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
3–2.4 Troubleshooting by means of the Craft Terminal
Troubleshooting proceeds by checking the detailed information on the NE alarm by using the CraftTerminal.
The information on the NE alarm will be mainly obtained by means of the Craft Terminal through the Alarmtab panel data.
The troubleshooting procedure is the following.
a ) Look at the active alarms on the Control Panel always present on the window (which summarizesall the NE alarms). Tab. 13. on page 221 describes the meanings of these alarms/statuses and itsrespective maintenance actions.
b ) In case of alarm, access the Alarm tab panel for troubleshooting.Para 3–2.4.2 on page 222 explains how to see the alarms.
MAJOR alarm indicates a severe alarm that could affect the current traffic (interrupt or degrade). Hence, a prompt intervention is necessary to restore the regular operating condition of the equipment.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
221
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
3–2.4.1 Alarm synthesis indication
The following troubleshooting table pertains to the alarm and status synthesis given in all the screens.
Tab. 13. Alarm Synthesis indication
Mnemonic Alarm / Status Description Maintenance
CRI Critical alarmSynthesis of alarms that needs immediatetroubleshooting (typical: NE isolation). NB1.
MAJ Major (Urgent) alarmSynthesis of alarms that needs immediate
MAJ Major (Urgent) alarmSynthesis of alarms that needs immediatetroublshooting. NB1.
MIN Minor (Not urgent) alarmSynthesis of alarms for which a deferred interventcan be decided. NB1.
WNG Warning alarmSynthesis of alarms due to failure of other NE in thenetwork. NB1.
IND Indeterminate alarmSynthesis of alarms not associated with the previousseverities. Not operative.
EXTPExternal Point(Housekeeping alarm)
Check the relevant station alarm associated with theinput housekeeping indication.
EQP Equipment alarm Synthesis of alarms of the Equipment domain.
TRNS Transmission alarm Synthesis of alarms of the Transmission domain.
SUP Supervision stateGREEN LED: NE is under supervision.BROWN LED: NE is not under supervision.Used in the OS.
Local Access state
GREEN LED: Indicates that the Craft Terminal hasthe OS permission to manage the NE (granted).CYAN LED: Indicates that the Craft Terminal has notthe OS permission to manage the NE (denied).
COM NE reachable/unreachable
GREEN LED: Identifies the “ Enable “ operationalstate of the connection between NE and Craft Terminal( SDH service link up ).RED LED: Identified the “ Disable ” operational stateof the connection between NE and Craft Terminal( service link down ).
AC Abnormal ConditionGREEN LED: Normal operating condition.CYAN LED: Detection of an ABNORMAL operativecondition. Type: switch forcing.
ALI AlignmentAlignment status of the SH MIB respect to theequipment MIB.
NB1: The Alarm Profile can modify the assignment of each alarm root to the various synthesis.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
222
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
3–2.4.2 Details on alarms / statuses
The troubleshooting proceed by checking the detailed information on the NE alarm by using the CraftTerminal.
To display the active alarms (refer to Fig. 152. on page 222):
It is also possible to analyze the detailed alarms present on each TP of the Port views of the NE.
[1] Select the Equipment tab panel.
[2] Select one node (or sub–node) in the Resourse Tree Area to check if some alarms are active.
[3] Select the Alarm tab panel in the Resourse Detail Area.
[4] If the node has sub–nodes put a tick in the Include alarms from sub–nodes field to display thealarms active also in the sub–nodes.
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
Fig. 152. Active alarm screem
Detailed information of some alarm are supplied.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
223
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
The following table summarizes the information obtained in the Alarm view, starting from the left column.
Tab. 14. Alarm information, general description
TITLE DESCRIPTION
Severity severity associated to the alarm and assigned in the Alarm Profile
Event time time of the generation of the alarm
Entity entity involved in the alarm
Probable Cause probable cause of the alarm
Managed Object Class class of the alarm
The information supplied helps the operator during the troubleshooting operations.
Tab. 15. on page 225 supplies general information on the alarm meanings and on the respectivemaintenance actions to be done bases on the information given in the applications.The maintenance action must take account of the board where the alarm is detected.
The Housekeeping alarms are referred to the input external point relevant to the Housekeeping signals.They are available to the customer by connecting them to a dedicated subrack connector.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
224
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
3–2.5 Description of alarms and of probable causes
The information provided helps the operator during troubleshooting operations.
N.B. UNIT REPLACEMENT
After having identified a unit to be replaced, in order to carry out the replacement correctly,please refer to:
9400AWY or 9400FSO Technical Handbooks,section MAINTENANCE
chapter SECOND LEVEL MAINTENANCE,paragraph UNIT REPLACEMENT PROCEDURES
WARNING:
Before to disconnect the cable IDU–ODU of N.E., the corresponding IDU unit must be alwaysturn–off.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
225
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Tab. 15. General issues of the alarm meanings and their respective maintenance actions
ALARM MEANING MAINTENANCE ACTION
AISAIS detection on the tributary in Txside or Rx side
Check the 2 Mbit connectedequipment
ATPC loop problem Problem on the ATPC loop Communication problem
Battery fail Problem on the Station Battery Check the Station Battery
High BER Excessive BERExcessive errors. Check the link(propagation problem)
Dem failDemodulator failure affecting thedemodulated signal
Replace the ODU
Dem LOSLoss of the incoming signal at thedemodulator input
Check the link (propagationproblem)
Cable LOS Problem on the cable or on the ODUReplace the ODU; if the alarm is stillactive replace the cable.
Incompatible FrequencyFrequency setting incompatible withthe ODU P/N
Change the frequency or change theODU
Incompatible PTX Output power out of the limits Replace the ODU
Internal CommunicationProblem
ODU not respondingPress the Reset pushbutton on theMAIN unit. If the alarm is still active,replace the ODU
LAN failure LAN problemCheck the LAN connection orreplace the MAIN unit
Link Identifier Mismatch Mismatch on the link identifier
Check the correct connection of thecable between the IDU and therelevant ODU. If the connection iscorrect, check the link (propagationproblem)
Loss Of Frame (E1/DS1)
LOF at the Tx tributary input or at Rxtributary output (with framedtributary) or LOF of the Rxaggregate signal
Check the E1/DS1 connectedequipment or the line
Loss Of Frame (Aggregatesignal)
LOF of the Rx aggregate signal Check the link (errors)
Loss Of Signal LOS at the Tx tributary input Check the line
Low BER Low BER at the Rx sideCheck the link (propagationproblem)
Mod failInternal modulator failure affectingthe modulated signal
Replace the ODU
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
226
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Tab. 15. General issues of the alarm meanings and their respective maintenance actions
ALARM MEANING MAINTENANCE ACTION
Mod LOS No signal at the modulator inputInvestigate by using the loopbackfacilities with the CT.
Remote Defect Indication Alarm active in the remote station Check the remote station
Replaceable Unit Problem Problem on a replaceable unit Replace the unit
Replaceable Unit TypeMismatch
Mismatch between the installed unitand the sw configured unit
Change the unit configuration orchange the unit
Replaceable Unit Type Missing No unit in a configured slot Install the unit
Rx Fail (Radio alarm) No RF received signalCheck the link (propagationproblem)
Rx LOS (FSO alarm) No Optical received signalCheck the link (propagationproblem)
Threshold CrossPerformance threshold has beencrossed
Errors on the link
Transmitter degraded (FSOalarm)
Laser degraded (output power 3 dBbelow the nominal power)
Minor alarm
Transmitter Failure (FSOalarm)
Transmitter failureReplace the ODU if the alarm ispresent at the same time on LASER1 and LASER
Tx Fail (Radio alarm) Transmitter failure Replace the ODU
Unconfigured EquipmentPresent
Unit present in an unconfigured slot Configure the unit
Version MismatchMismatch on the software versionbetween CT software andequipment software
Download the software version
Housekeeping Active input housekeeping Check the housekeeping
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
227
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
SECTION 4: SWP DESCRIPTION AND VERSIONS
This section gives information on the Software Packages this handbook refers to, and that are bothindependent and independent on the specific SWP Versions.
SECTION CONTENT PAGE
INFORMATION INDEPENDENT ON THE SPECIFIC SWP VERSIONS
Chapter 4–1 – SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 descriptionThis chapter gives information on the Software Packages this handbook refers to,and that are independent on the specific SWP Version: commercial information(SWP and Software Licences P/Ns).
229
INFORMATION ON THE SPECIFIC SWP VERSIONSThese chapters give operative information regarding the Software Package Version1.0.x, starting from version V1.0.0: requirements (PC and equipment Firmware), SWPackage Identification, SW Package Components, ECT SW Sub–Component, NEMIB Compatibility, new features, restrictions and known problems.
Chapter 4–2 – SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V.1.0.0 specific informationN.B. Version 1.0.0 manages the Radio application only (1+0 configuration).
231
Chapter 4–3 – SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V.1.0.1 specific informationN.B. Version 1.0.1 manages the Radio application (1+0 and 1+1
configurations) and the FSO application.235
Chapter 4–4 – SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V.1.0.2 specific information 239
The symbol points out references to other handbooks.
Referenced handbook P/Ns are given in Appendix E on page 273.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
228
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
229
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–1 SWP 9400AWY R.1.0 DESCRIPTION
This chapter gives commercial information regarding the Software Packages this handbook refers to, i.e.the SWP and Software Licences P/Ns.
4–1.1 General
The software products are distributed by Alcatel in a CD–ROM.
In this CD–ROM are contained:
• Software packages for NE management by means of the craft terminal
• Software package of the NE, to be installed in the NE or update the NE (by means of downloadfunction)
The software package used for management allows the dialogue between craft terminal and NE, torealize all the functions of the NE and EML–ULS ).
The software package used for updating the NE must be installed on the PC and then downloaded onthe NE, thus following product evolution.
Alcatel typically offers several software licences on the software product.
They are referred both to the Network Element software features and to the Craft Terminal softwarefeatures.
4–1.2 Software product list and part numbers
Every Software Product is identified by a denomination and a part number and is distributed by a CD–ROMwith the same identifiers, listed on the following table:
Tab. 16. Software products part numbers
Name ANV Part NumberFactory
Part NumberN.B.
SWP 9400 AWY R.1.0 CD–ROM 3DB 04798 AAAA 415.201.017 Y 1
N.B. 1 Software Package associated to LCT or RCT SW Licence ( For AWY/FSO ULS NEs).See para.4–1.3 on page 230 for additional information.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
230
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–1.3 Software licence list and part numbers
Every Software licence is identified by a denomination and a part number, listed on the following table.
Tab. 17. Software licence part numbers
Name ANV Part NumberFactory
Part NumberN.B.
SWL–ULS R1.0 FEE 3DB 05638 AAAA 700.500.050 P 1, 3
SWL–LCT 9400 AWY R1.0 FEE 3DB 04811 AAAA 700.500.028 D2 3
SWL–RCT 9400 AWY R1.0 FEE 3DB 04812 AAAA 700.500.029 E2, 3
N.B. 1 Licence for Network Element software features (one per Transceiver):
2 Licence alternative for Craft Terminal software features:• SWL–LCT: local Craft Terminal functionality• SWL–RCT: remote Craft Terminal functionality.
3 Software licence valid for AWY and FSO application.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
231
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–2 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V1.0.0 SPECIFIC INFORMATION
This chapter gives operative information regarding the Software Package Version 1.0.0: requirements (PCand equipment Firmware), SW Package Identification, SW Package Components, ECT SWSub–Component, NE MIB Compatibility, new features, restrictions and known problems.
For versions higher than V1.0.0 please refer to next chapters of this section.
Please refer to para.E.2.5.2 on page 286 for the meaning of SWP Release, Version and Patch Level.
N.B. With reference to the Versions stated in this chapter, please read carefully theN.B. on page 274.
4–2.1 ECT requirements
For ECT installation it is necessary a PC with the requirements hereafter described:
1 ) HW Configuration
– CPU: Pentium III 850 MHz– RAM: 256 Mbytes (512 Mbytes suggested for Windows XP)– Hard Disk space: 4 Gbytes– Display Resolution: 1024x768 pixel– CD–ROM Drive: 24X– Primary Interface: Serial Port RS–232–C 9.6 to 57.6 Kbits/sec.– Optional Interface: Ethernet Card 10/100 Mbits/sec.
2 ) Windows Versions
– Windows NT 4.0 SP3 till SP6– Windows 2000 till SP4– Windows XP till SP1
3 ) Additional requirements
– Netscape Communicator or MS Internet Explorer 4.x or higher.– Java 2 Run Time Environment versions from 1.3.1–06 to 1.4.1–04
N.B. Each specific Java version could require minimal Windows SP installation.
4 ) Additional information
– On IDU PQ/ECRC controller it is requested a Raw Loader version V8.1.0 of May 22nd,2003 or higher.
– Reference SNMP–IM version: 2.14 (SGPA 3.2.4+).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
232
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–2.2 SWP version specific data
N.B. With reference to the Versions stated on this page, please read carefully theN.B. on page 274.
4–2.2.1 SW Package Identification
Identification Version Date
SWP REG. 9400AWY R1.0 V1.0.0 April 19th, 2004
4–2.2.2 SW Package Components
Name Description Version
SWP REG. 9400AWY R1.0SW Package for 2G Radio Regenerator LowCapacity PDH Equipments
V1.0.0
SWC–ECT9400AWY_V10 Equipment Craft Terminal SW Component V1.0.0
SWC–EC9400AWY_V10 Equipment Controller SW Component V1.0.0
SWC–OCR9400AWY_V10 ODU Radio Controller SW Component V1.4.4
SWC–OCF9400AWY_V10 ODU FSO Controller SW Component V1.0.19
SWC–FD9400AWY_V10 File Descriptor for SW Download Component V1.0.0
4–2.2.3 ECT SW Sub–Components
Name Version Description
JRE V1.4.1–04 Java 2 Run Time Environment
LLMAN V3.3.2 Lower Layers Manager
CT–K V3.0.2 P5 Craft Terminal Base Platform
CT–K SNMP Add–On V3.0.3 P2 Craft Terminal Base Platform SNMP Add–On (EML–IM)
CT–K HOL Add–On V1.0.0 P2 Craft Terminal Base Platform Help On–Line Add–On
JUSM–SNMP–COMMON V1.0.0 User Service Manager for SNMP MW NEs
JUSM–SNMP–HELP V0.1.0 Help On–Line for SNMP MW NEs
CT–K Q3 Add–On V3.0.3 P2 Craft Terminal Base Platform Q3 Add–On (EML–IM)
4–2.2.4 NE MIB Compatibility
NE MIB it is not compatible with previous versions (this is the first version) and has to be manuallyconfigured.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
233
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–2.3 New features and modifications
Not Applicable for first release.
N.B. Version 1.0.0 manages the Radio application only (1+0 configuration).
4–2.4 Restrictions and known problems
– For a corrected operation, only on some PC with Windows 2000 or XP using serial connection, dueto an unidentified problem to be solved by ECT Platform, it is necessary to start Low Layers Managerbefore to start ECT Platform (Alcatel 1320CT).
– Alarm Surveillance: the application closure is followed by a message error (with Windows NT only).No impact in the functionality.
– At first activation sometimes, after NES opening, the message “ANTP: Unrecoverable error” appearsalso with ANTP deactivasted (with Windows NT only).No impact in the functionality.
– SNMP Agent it is not able to correctly manage event reporting when IP addresses are different onNMS ports and Ethernet port.
4–2.5 New features and modifications of SWP versions higher than V.1.0.0
Please refer to next chapters of this section.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
234
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
235
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–3 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V1.0.1 SPECIFIC INFORMATION
This chapter gives operative information regarding the Software Package Version 1.0.1: requirements (PCand equipment Firmware), SW Package Identification, SW Package Components, ECT SWSub–Component, NE MIB Compatibility, new features, restrictions and known problems.
For versions higher than V1.0.1 please refer to next chapters of this section.
Please refer to para.E.2.5.2 on page 286 for the meaning of SWP Release, Version and Patch Level.
N.B. With reference to the Versions stated in this chapter, please read carefully theN.B. on page 274.
4–3.1 ECT requirements
As for V.1.0.0 (see para.4–2.1 on page 231).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
236
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–3.2 SWP version specific data
N.B. With reference to the Versions stated on this page, please read carefully theN.B. on page 274.
4–3.2.1 SW Package Identification
Identification Version Date
SWP REG. 9400AWY R1.0 V1.0.1 July 8th, 2004
4–3.2.2 SW Package Components
Name Description Version
SWP REG. 9400AWY R1.0SW Package for 2G Radio Regenerator Low CapacityPDH Equipments
V1.0.1
SWC–ECT9400AWY_V10 Equipment Craft Terminal SW Component V1.0.1
SWC–EC9400AWY_V10 Equipment Controller SW Component V1.0.4
SWC–OCR9400AWY_V10 ODU Radio Controller SW Component V1.4.12
SWC–OCF9400AWY_V10 ODU FSO Controller SW Component V1.1.0
SWC–FD9400AWY_V10 File Descriptor for SW Download Component V1.0.1
4–3.2.3 ECT SW Sub–Components
Name Version Description
JRE V1.4.1–04 Java 2 Run Time Environment
LLMAN V3.3.2 Lower Layers Manager
CT–K V3.0.3 P4a Craft Terminal Base Platform
CT–K SNMP Add–On V3.1.0 P1b Craft Terminal Base Platform SNMP Add–On (EML–IM)
CT–K HOL Add–On V1.0.0 P2 Craft Terminal Base Platform Help On–Line Add–On
JUSM–SNMP–COMMON V1.0.2 User Service Manager for SNMP MW NEs
JUSM–SNMP–HELP V0.1.1 Help On–Line for SNMP MW NEs
CT–K Q3 Add–On V3.0.3 P2 Craft Terminal Base Platform Q3 Add–On (EML–IM)
4–3.2.4 NE MIB Compatibility
NE MIB it is automatically converted from previous released versions 1.0.0.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
237
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–3.3 New features and modifications
With respect to the previous SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V1.0.0, the SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V1.0.1introduces the following features and modifications:
a ) Version 1.0.1 manages the Radio application (1+0 and 1+0 Exp/1+1 configurations) and the FSOapplication.
b ) Inserted new management for polarity configuration by CT on Summarizing alarms.
c ) It has been modified to “onlyLocal” the tipology of Near–End Tributary E3/DS3 loopback.
d ) It has been extended the management of “Service Kit Connected” alarm for Pegaso ASIC alignment(1 bit of 1 register).
e ) Improved management of Soft–Reset associated to new version of Traminer CPLD.
f ) Improved management of “Lac State” in caso of NMS system already connected.
g ) It has been extended the loopback management to enable the functionality also to NMS system.
h ) Improved management of “CardFail” alarm to speed–up HST switching.
i ) It has been extended the management of “LossOfSignal” alarm also in case of Auxiliary Interfaceconfigured as V11 Codirectional.
j ) Improved management of maintenance operations control.
k ) Improved management of alarms related to EPS TX switch position.
l ) Improved management of 1+1 configurations for both ETSI and FCC systems.
m ) Improved management of IDU–ODU connection in case of on–line modification of system capacityand/or modulation.
n ) Improved management of Protections control features.
o ) Improved management of Performance Monitoring features.
p ) Improved management of TMN–RF pointToPoint in case of on–line modification of system capacity.
q ) It has been completed the correct management of HST switch in case of contemporary presence ofthe alarms (TX Fail and RUP).
r ) It has been resolved the problem on incorrect reporting of MAC Address value associated to LANinterface.
s ) It has been inserted a new version of OC Radio SW, aligned to the same version used on UXFLAT1+0 configuration, with the following modifications:• Tx Power filtered on Tx Power configuration changement• Frequency plan V06 modified on local loop for the RX base band LO Frequency• IDU detection at ODU startup improvement• Inhibition of the reading ODU remote received power level interruption, for ATPC• Correction of a bug in the temperature regulation for the overload attenuator• Modification of DCA thresholds, for UxFlat• Configuration saving on data changed only, for UxFlat• New Perseo parameters to improve 16QAM/8E1, for UxFlat• Use of MVT detection for all the rates in 4QAM, for UxFlat• New Perseo parameters to improve 4QAM/8E1, for UxFlat
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
238
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–3.4 Restrictions and known problems
– For a corrected operation, only on some PC with Windows 2000 or XP using serial connection, dueto an unidentified problem to be solved by ECT Platform, it is necessary to start Low Layers Managerbefore to start ECT Platform (Alcatel 1320CT).
– Alarm Surveillance: the application closure is followed by a message error (with Windows NT only).No impact in the functionality.
– At first activation sometimes, after NES opening, the message “ANTP: Unrecoverable error” appearsalso with ANTP deactivasted (with Windows NT only).No impact in the functionality.
4–3.5 Operative hints
a ) Installation procedure
It is the same of previous version 1.0.0 but it is necessary to select “Forced” option on CT screen forSW Download activation request. This warning has been introduced in relevant procedures:
• para.1–2.3 on page 60
• chapter 1–3 on page 75
b ) Configuration change from “1+0 extendable” to “1+1” (9400AWY only)
Some ways to proceed for this configuration change do not give good results. The suggestedprocedure has been introduced in para.2–3.1.3 on page 131.
4–3.6 New features and modifications of SWP versions higher than V.1.0.1
Please refer to next chapters of this section.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
239
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–4 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V1.0.2 SPECIFIC INFORMATION
PRELIMINARY INFORMATION
This chapter gives operative information regarding the Software Package Version 1.0.2: requirements (PCand equipment Firmware), SW Package Identification, SW Package Components, ECT SWSub–Component, NE MIB Compatibility, new features, restrictions and known problems.
Please refer to para.E.2.5.2 on page 286 for the meaning of SWP Release, Version and Patch Level.
N.B. With reference to the Versions stated in this chapter, please read carefully theN.B. on page 274.In case you receive a SWP with version higher than that stated, please refer tothe documentation accompanying the SWP delivery to get this information.
4–4.1 ECT requirements
As for V.1.0.0 (see para.4–2.1 on page 231).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
240
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
4–4.2 SWP version specific data
N.B. With reference to the Versions stated on this page, please read carefully theN.B. on page 274.
4–4.2.1 SW Package Identification
Identification Version Date
SWP REG. 9400AWY R1.0 V1.0.2c November 10th, 2004
4–4.2.2 SW Package Components
Name Description Version
SWP REG. 9400AWY R1.0SW Package for 2G Radio Regenerator Low CapacityPDH Equipments
V1.0.2c
SWC–ECT9400AWY_V10 Equipment Craft Terminal SW Component V1.0.2
SWC–EC9400AWY_V10 Equipment Controller SW Component V1.0.8
SWC–OCR9400AWY_V10 ODU Radio Controller SW Component V1.4.29
SWC–OCF9400AWY_V10 ODU FSO Controller SW Component V1.1.0
SWC–FD9400AWY_V10 File Descriptor for SW Download Component V1.0.2
4–4.2.3 ECT SW Sub–Components
Name Version Description
JRE V1.4.1–04 Java 2 Run Time Environment
LLMAN V3.3.2 Lower Layers Manager
CT–K V3.0.3 P4a Craft Terminal Base Platform
CT–K SNMP Add–On V3.1.0 P1b Craft Terminal Base Platform SNMP Add–On (EML–IM)
CT–K HOL Add–On V1.0.0 P2 Craft Terminal Base Platform Help On–Line Add–On
JUSM–SNMP–COMMON V1.0.5 User Service Manager for SNMP MW NEs
JUSM–SNMP–HELP V1.0.1 Help On–Line for SNMP MW NEs
CT–K Q3 Add–On V3.0.3 P2 Craft Terminal Base Platform Q3 Add–On (EML–IM)
4–4.2.4 NE MIB Compatibility
NE MIB it is automatically converted from previous released version 1.0.0 and it is compatible with lastreleased version 1.0.1 and previous pre–releases 1.0.2x.
4–4.3 New features and modifications
t.b.d.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
241
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
SECTION 5: APPENDICES
SECTION CONTENT PAGE
Appendix A – Equipment description and componentsThis Appendix sums–up the equipment functions and defines its components fromthe SW point of view.
243
Appendix B – SW allocation, Flash Card and equipment controlThis Appendix presents the software allocation in the various parts of the equipment,the types of Flash Card and its contents, and the general characteristics of the ECTand RECT.
251
Appendix C – General on SWP installationThis Appendix introduces the basic information regarding the software installation.
259
Appendix D – ECT–Equipment connection via public switched telephonenetwork
This Appendix explains the operations necessary to allow the remote connection tothe F–Interface, from a local PC configurated as ECT, through a switched telephoneline of the standard Public Telephone Network.
263
Appendix E – Documentation GuideThis Appendix contains all information regarding this handbook (purpose,applicability, history) and the Customer Documentation set it belongs to, in particularthe list of the handbooks the Operators should have in order to carry out the requiredoperations.
273
Appendix F – Acronyms and abbreviations 289
Appendix G – Glossary of terms 293
The symbol points out references to Other Handbooks.
Referenced handbook P/Ns are given in para.E.2 on page 279.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
242
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
243
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
APPENDIX A : EQUIPMENT DESCRIPTION AND COMPONENTS
This appendix sums–up the equipment functions and defines its components from the SW point of view:
– Functions and configurations on page 244
– IDU and ODU Components on page 245:
• IDU on page 245
• ODU on page 246
• Allowed Equipment Types on page 247
• Remote Inventory Management on page 249
For more detailed in formation from the hardware point of view, please refer to:
9400 AWY Technical Handbook
or:
9400 FSO Technical Handbook
From the software point of view, the equipment management is carried out as explained in Section 2AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT on page 77, in chapters relevant to the EQUIPMENT CONFIGURATIONMANAGEMENT .
The equipment type HSW indicated in Tab. 21. on page 248 is not managed in current SWPversion.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
244
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
A.1 : Functions and configurations
ULS NE (9400AWY and 9400FSO) has the aim to multiplexer/demultiplexer the main tributaries (up to 16E1/16 DS1 or 1 E3/1 DS3) with different modulation formats.The following Tab. 18. summarizes the relation among market, product type tributaries and modulation.
Tab. 18. Markets, product type, tributaries and modulations forecasted
Market Product Type Tributary Modulation
2xE1 4QAM
4xE1 4QAM / 16QAM
AWY 8xE1 4QAM /16QAM
ETSI 16xE1 4QAM / 16QAM
1xE3 4QAM / 16QAM
FSO16xE1 4PSK
FSO1xE3 4PSK
4xDS1 4QAM
ANSI AWY8xDS1 4QAM / 16QAM
ANSI AWY16xDS1 4QAM / 16QAM
1xDS3 4QAM / 16QAM
The main functions performed by IDU and ODU of ULS equipment are the following:
– Multiplexer/DemultiplexerThe multiplexer function receives main tributaries (see Tab. 18. ) and generates a PDH frame.The demultiplexer function receives a PDH frame and generates main tributaries.
– Signal Protection switch (if any)The function provides one protection channel for the main signal against channel–associated failuresfor both hardware failures and temporary signals degradation or losses due to propagation effects(e.g. rain) according to equipment configuration.
– Radio Physical Interface (AWY)The function converts a radio frequency signal into an internal logic level signal, and vice versa(RPPI). Specifically, the following functions are performed:• Modulation and Tx functions in the transmit side• Demodulation and Rx functions in the receive side
– Free Space Optics (FSO)The function converts an optical signal into an internal logic level signal, and vice versa. Specifically,the following functions are performed:• Modulation and Tx functions in the transmit side• Demodulation and Rx functions in the receive side
ULS NE can be composed by:– one channel (1+0 configurations and 1+0 extendible configurations);– two channels (1+1 configurations).
The FSO is supported only in 1+0 configuration. The 2+0 and N+1 configurations are not supported.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
245
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
A.2 : IDU and ODU Components
The ULS NE is composed by two different parts: the indoor and the outdoor part. In the following they aredescribed from physical and management point of view.
A.2.1 : IDU
The indoor part is composed by one shelf (see Fig. 153. and Fig. 154. ). It contains the following units:
– (1+0) IDU• slot 1: ACCESS Unit• slot 2: Main Unit
slot 1: ACCESS Unit
slot 2: MAIN Unit
Fig. 153. (1+0) IDU
– (1+1) and (1+0 expandable) IDU• slot 1: ACCESS Unit• slot 2: Extension Unit• slot 3: Main Unit• slot 4: FAN unit
slot 1: ACCESS Unit
slot 2: EXTENSION Unit (N.B.)
slot 3: MAIN Unit
slot 4:FANUnit
Fig. 154. (1+1) and (1+0 expandable) IDU
N.B. In the 1+1 sub–equipped configurations (1+0 EXPANDABLE), slot 2 is not used.
The ACCESS unit accommodates the connectors referred to E1/E3/DS1/DS3 tributaries, user servicechannel, housekeeping and summarizing, NMS V11 and G703 interfaces, and a telephone jack.
The Main Unit contains the MULDEM, the PQECRC and the Power Supply units. The MULDEM unitmanages the ETSI 1xE3/16xE1 and ANSI 1xDS3/16xDS1 tributaries, the Mux/Demux and the cableinterface functions. The PQECRC unit implements the Equipment and IDU Controller functions. The Dataunit implementing Ethernet functions can be plugged onto the Main unit. It is not supported in the currentrelease. The Main unit is used both in 1+0 and 1+1 configurations.
The Extension Unit contains the MULDEM and the Power Supply units. The Hitless unit and the Data unitimplementing Ethernet functions can be plugged onto the Extension unit. Data unit is not supported in thecurrent release. The Extension unit is used only in 1+1 configurations.
The FAN unit contains fans in order to provide the necessary ventilation to the IDU shelf (t is supportedonly in “1+0 expandable” and “1+1 configurations”). Only the FAN unit is shown at SNMP interface,independently from the number of fans composing it.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
246
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
A.2.2 : ODU
According to the configuration type, two ODU types are managed in the Outdoor part. They can be:– ODU (electrical ODU)– ODUFSO (optical ODU)
The ODU type is implicitly defined by the NE configuration. Each ODU contains a PQECRC unit whichimplements the ODU Controller functions.
ODU / ODUFSO
Fig. 155. (1+0) ODU (electrical or optical)
ODU Ch#1 ODU Ch#2
Fig. 156. (1+1) ODU (only electrical)
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
247
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
A.2.3 : Allowed Equipment Types
This paragraph provides information on the allowed equipment types for all the configurations supportedby ULS NE.
[1] Shelves Equipment Types
The following Tab. 19. provides the shelves equipment types allowed for each supported NEconfiguration and market type:
Tab. 19. Shelves Equipment Types
NEConfiguration
MarketType
Shelfposition
Allowed Equipment TypeDescription
AllowedEquipment
Type
EquipmentLabel
(note 1) 1 IDU 1+0 Shelf IDU10 IDU
1+0 ETSI2
ODU 1+0 4/16 QAM ETSI ODU–EODU Ch#1
ANSI2
ODU 1+0 4/16 QAM ANSI ODU–AODU Ch#1
1+0 FSO(note 1) 1 IDU 1+0 Shelf IDU10 IDU
1+0 FSOETSI 2 ODU 1+0 FSO ETSI ODUFSO–E ODUFSO
(note 1) 1 IDU 1+1 Shelf IDU11 IDU
1 1ETSI
2ODU 1+0 4/16 QAM ETSI ODU–E
ODU Ch#11+1(note 2)
ANSI2
ODU 1+0 4/16 QAM ANSI ODU–AODU Ch#1
(note 2)ETSI
3ODU 1+0 4/16 QAM ETSI ODU–E
ODU Ch#0ANSI
3ODU 1+0 4/16 QAM ANSI ODU–A
ODU Ch#0
(note 1) The equipment types allowed for IDU shelf are market type independent.
(note 2) All the 1+1 configurations. In case of 1+0 extendible configurations shelf position 3 is notsupported.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
248
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
[2] : Slots and Sub–slots Equipment Types
The following tables indicate the allowed equipment types for each slot inside each shelf type andif the equipment expected value is settable by the operator.
• IDU
Tab. 20. IDU allowed board/plug–in types in (1+0) configurations
IDU10
Position Allowed Equipment Type DescriptionAllowed
EquipmentType
EquipmentLabel
1.1 Access Unit ACCESS IDU/ACCESS
1.2Main Unit ±24V Range Supply
Main Unit ±48/±60 V Range SupplyMain Unit ±48/±60 V Range High Power Supply (N.B.)
M24M4860
M4860H
IDU/MAINCh#1
N.B. This power supply (“high power” version) is allowed only in case of 1+0 FSO configuration.
Tab. 21. IDU allowed board/plug–in types in (1+1) and (1+0 expandable) configurations
IDU11
Position Allowed Equipment Type DescriptionAllowed
EquipmentType
EquipmentLabel
1.1 Access Unit ACCESS IDU/ACCESS
1.2(note 1)
Not provisionedExtension Unit ±24V Range Supply
Extension Unit ±48/±60 V Range Supply
EMPTYE24
E4860IDU/EXT Ch#0
1.2.1(note 2)
Hitless Switch unit (not managed in current SWPversion)
HSWIDU/EXT/HSW
Ch#0
1.3Main Unit ±24V Range Supply
Main Unit ±48/±60 V Range SupplyM24
M4860IDU/MAIN Ch#1
1.4 FAN unit FAN IDU/FAN
(note 1) In the 1+1 sub–equipped configurations this slot is empty.
(note 2) Position 1.2.1 is created only in the 1+1 Hitless configurations (HST and FD).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
249
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
• Electrical ODUNo slot can be defined inside the Electrical ODU.
• Optical ODU
Tab. 22. Allowed board types in optical ODU ETSI
ODUFSO–E
Position Allowed Equipment Type DescriptionAllowed
EquipmentType
EquipmentLabel
2.1 Optical Interface ETSI board OPINT–E ODUFSO/OPINT
2.2 Optical Transceiver board OPTR ODUFSO/OPTR
A.2.4 : Remote Inventory Management
The Remote Inventory feature allows to store the information useful to identify the components of theproduct.From management point of view the Remote Inventory data will be provided by the following equipmenttypes:– Main Unit (M24, M4860, M4860H)– Extension Unit (E24, E4860)– Hitless Switch Unit (HSW) (not managed in current SWP version)– Access Unit (ACCESS)– FAN unit (FAN)– ODU unit (ODU–E, ODU–A )– ODU FSO unit (ODUFSO–E)
For all the other equipment types the remoteInventoryStatus columnar object assumes the value“unavailable”.The RI data of each sub–components unit (i.e. MULDEM in the IDU, MILOU in the ODU, OPTR in theODUFSO) won’t be seen at SNMP management interface but only by means of factory tools.Also the information about the equipment type can be read from the remote inventory data (‘Unitmnemonic’ field). All the units are provided in its own remote inventory data this type of information. It isused to identify the actual equipment type and then, eventually, to provide an equipment mismatch alarm,if the equipment type read from remote inventory data is different from the equipment expected providedby the managers.If it isn’t possible to read the Remote Inventory information, a “Card Fail” alarm is declared.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
250
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
251
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
APPENDIX B : SW ALLOCATION, FLASH CARD AND EQUIPMENT CONTROL
This Appendix presents:– the software allocation in the various parts of the equipment, herebelow– the types of Flash Card and its contents, on page 254– the general characteristics of the ECT and RECT, on page 256.
Fig. 157. herebelow shows the Interfaces for equipment control
Fig. 158. herebelow shows the MAIN UNIT + FLASH CARD unit assembly view
Fig. 159. herebelow shows the FLASH CARD profile and insertion direction
Ethernet Interfacefor OS connection
F Interfacefor ECT connection
Flash cardlabel
Fig. 157. Interfaces for equipment control and Flash card label on MAIN Unit
FLASH CARD
EQUIPMENT CONTROLLER BABY BOARD (PQ/ECRC)
MAIN BOARD
FRONT PLATE
Fig. 158. MAIN unit + FLASH CARD
TOP SIDE
INSERTION
Fig. 159. FLASH CARD profile and insertion direction
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
252
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
B.1 : Allocation of equipment and craft terminal software
Fig. 160. herebelow roughly depicts the NE main parts containing the local SW and the interfaces with theOperator (Extension Unit and RT–0 are present in 1+1 configuration and are not equipped in 1+0compact/expandable configurations).
FLASHCARD
EQUIPMENTCONTROLLER
RAM
MULDEMSUBUNIT
PQ/ECRC SUBUNIT
F
Ethernet
MAIN UNIT
EXTENSION UNIT
RT–0
ODUCONTROLLER
MULDEMSUBUNIT
FLASHEPROM
RAM
RT–1
ODUCONTROLLER
FLASHEPROM
RAM
Fig. 160. Equipment main parts containing local SW
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
253
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
c ) Local software allocation
Once the system has been configured and activated (as explained in Section 1 Installation),Equipment and Craft Terminal must not necessarily be left connected, because equipment containsall the software necessary for its working.
This equipment local software comprises programs and configuration data. Programs and data aremanaged differently from each other:
1 ) Equipment ControllerWhole Equipment SW (programs and configuration data) is contained in the Flash Card housedin MAIN unit’s PQ/ECRC sub–unit (the Flash Card contains also the software (programs andconfiguration data) relevant to the peripheral units, i.e., in the figure RTs). See Fig. 158. andFig. 159. on page 251.This flash card is removable (i.e. replaceable), and the programs can be overwritten by a SWdownload from CT (through F interface) or Network Management Operation System (throughEthernet interface) to the MAIN unit.More precisely, the Flash Card contains two independent instances of the Equipment SWprograms (one active, the other stand–by), so that the above cited SW download is actuallydone toward the stand–by instance, while equipment goes on working with the SW programsof the active instance. Swapping between the two instances is done only under Operator’srequest.
2 ) Peripheral UnitsThe Peripheral units (RTs) contain their own local SW (programs and configuration data),housed in a local Flash Eprom (physically not removable). The programs in this local FlashEprom can be overwritten by means of a SW download from the Equipment Controller with thesame active–standby duplication described before for the Equipment Controller.
3 ) Equipment Configuration Data (MIB)The whole equipment configuration data (together with programs) are stored in the MAIN unitPQ/ECRC sub–unit Flash Card. Refer to point B.2.3 on page 255 for details.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
254
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
B.2 : Flash Card
B.2.1 : Flash Card types
A FLASH CARD is plugged into the Main board (see Fig. 158. on page 251) giving the maximum capacityfor the tributaries and the modulation type as reported in the following Tab. 23. (5 possible types of Flashcard).
Tab. 23. Available Flash cards
Flash Card Name Capacity Modulation
Full Flexible Flash Card Full flexible Full flexible
16xE1/DS1 16 QAM Flash Card Full flexible 16 QAM
4xE1/DS1 16 QAM Flash Card Up to 4xE1/DS1 16 QAM
16xE1/DS1 4 QAM Flash Card Full flexible 4 QAM
4xE1/DS1 4 QAM Flash Card Up to 4xE1/DS1 4 QAM
Notes:
1 ) A 16 QAM Flash card does not allow the transmission of a 4 QAM signal.
2 ) A 4xE1/DS1 Flash Card does not allow the transmission of a capacity greater than 4xE1/DS1.
3 ) As far as E3/DS3 tributary rate is concerned, only the Full Flexible Flash card can be selected.
4 ) The Full Flexible Flash Card allows the transmission of whatever capacity and modulation.
5 ) In 9400FSO equipment, only the Full Flexible Flash Card can be used.
6 ) For the P/Ns of the Flash Card types please refer to the:
9400 AWY/FSO Technical Handbook,section “System composition and configurations”
chapter “IDU part list“
B.2.2 : Flash Card identification
a ) the Flash Card P/N is reported on the label affixed on it;
b ) moreover, the Flash Card Name is affixed on the label present on the front panel of the MainUnit (see Fig. 157. on page 251).
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
255
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
B.2.3 : Flash Card contentsThe following table indicates the FLASH CARD contents in the various phases of SW management:
NE DATA
PHASEBASE
CONFIGURATIONSW PROGRAMS ROUTING
CONFIGURATIONn.b.2
MIBn.b.1
1 ) As suppliedby Factory Defined by Flash
Not present Not present Not present
2 ) After SWPdownload
yCard P/N.Not changeable,but with Flash Present
To be defined byC.T.
To be defined byC.T.
3 ) After NE datadefinition
but with FlashCard upgrade(see para B.2.4
Present
Present Present
MODIFICABILITY⇒
(see para B.2.4herebelow) By a new SWP
download n.b.4Yes, by C.T. Yes, by C.T.
SAVE/RESTORE⇒ NO Unmeaningful NO NO n.b.3
NE= Network Element C.T. = Craft Terminal SWP= Software Package
n.b.1 MIBThe system configuration data set is named MIB. Such data are defined by Craft Terminal afterthe SWP download. They can be changed only within the limits implicitly defined by theemployed Flash Card type. For its save/restore refer to n.b.3 herebelow.
n.b.2 ROUTING CONFIGURATION DATAThey are:
1. Local configuration ⇒ System’s local address2. NTP server configuration3. Interface configuration ⇒ NMS configuration
⇒ Ethernet configuration4. IP configuration ⇒ IP Static Routing configuration
⇒ OSPF AREA configuration
All those listed parameter are NOT stored into the MIB file because considered unique to aparticular system in a network and are NOT meant to be reproduced on other systems in thesame network because will cause conflicts in the supervision network centre.
n.b.3 The MIB file save/restore to/from a file in the Craft Terminal (or OS) environment is not possiblein SWP first version(s). It should be possible in future versions(s).
n.b.4 A new SWP download is envisaged whenever a new SWP package version or release (new withrespect to that presently loaded in the system) is supplied to Customer (*).
(*) for the meaning of SWP package version and release refer to para.E.2.5.2 on page 286.
B.2.4 : Flash Card upgrade (for 9400AWY only)Refer to the instructions given in the:
9400AWY Technical Handbook, section “System composition and configurations”chapter “IDU operative information“, para.”Flash Card”
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
256
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
B.3 : Equipment control
B.3.1 : Interfaces (see Fig. 157. on page 251):
• The NE can be controlled by the OS (e.g. Alcatel 1353SH) through the Ethernet interface.
• ECT (Equipment Craft Terminal, briefly Craft Terminal) can be connected to the MAIN unitthrough a RS232 interface (F interface). This connection can be:
– local (ECT) through a suitable cable supplied with the equipment, or remote (RECT) asexplained in para.B.3 on page 256
– remote through a ECT–equipment connection via public switched telephone network, asexplained in Appendix D on page 263.
B.3.2 : Operator–Equipment Interaction
1 ) The Local Operator can manage the Equipment software programs and most configuration datathrough the Equipment Craft Terminal 1320CT connected to the F interface (see Fig. 160. onpage 252 and Fig. 157. on page 251).The Craft Terminal characteristics (computer configuration) are listed in chapter 4–2 on page231.The Craft Terminal is a project in charge of the local management of single network elements,providing ITU– compliant Information Model Interface to the Network Element.Multiple NE management up to 128 Network elements is possible obtaining a remote CraftTerminal application.
The general information on the Craft Terminal is presented in the:
1320CT Basic Craft Terminal Operator’s Handbook
that the operator has to read before this Handbook.In this Handbook is given the general description regarding use, navigation, rules, etc., commonto all the NE using the same Craft Terminal.Furthermore, the same handbook contains the detailed description of common operations as“Installation” and common screens as “Network Element Synthesis view”.The Network Element Synthesis view is the first view presented to the operator entering theapplication.Starting from this view it is possible to login to the NE and then to enter the EML–ULS views.This Operator’s Handbook deals with the EML–ULS views of the Craft Terminal, which directlyallows to manage the Network Element.
A detailed description of the AWY/FSO’s EML–ULS screens is given in the dedicated Sections
2–AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT and 3–AWY/FSO MAINTENANCE of this handbook.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
257
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
2 ) A further SW application, also available in the PC and OS environment and named SIBDL(Standard Image Binary Download), deals with the SW download in special cases, which aredetailed in the following. The physical interface for running this application from Craft Terminalis ’F’ interface.The installation and use of SIBDL is detailed in the dedicated Section of the:
9400AWY Line Up Guide
or
9400FSO Line Up Guide
B.3.3 : ECT
ALCATEL TMN management products 1320 CT called Craft Terminals (CT) consists of a compatiblepersonal computer and application software specially developed for monitoring transmissionequipment. The CT designed to monitor a single transmission equipment is called Equipment CraftTerminal (ECT) or 1320CT.
For each 9600USY&MDR9000s station an ALCATEL proprietary SWP (SoftWare Package) isemployed, which depends on the product–release and the NE (Network Element) associated to thespecific configuration.
B.3.4 : RECT
The Remote Equipment Craft Terminal is a feature only present in the Single NE Link architecturewhich allows the local operator, using an ECT connected to the F interface of the NE, to zoom andperform a complete set of management operations on all the reachable NEs in the network.The Remote NE can be physically reached through the NMS channels or Ethernet LAN.RECT can be connected to any NE pertaining to the same area of the local NE and to any NEpertaining to different areas (assuming that the DCN network has been correctly designed and henceinter–area communication is possible from networking viewpoint).Of course, due to the limitation of the physical resources in the Equipment Controller of the NE, somenetwork design constraints must be taken into account as the total number of managed NEs (128).
The RECT features and limitations are briefly the following:
1 ) The RECT function provides a remote login facility similar to those offered by an OS to manageseveral configured NEs, included the local one.
2 ) The contemporaneous presence of the RECT function and an OS is possible. The accessdisable flag avoids access conflict between the OS and both RECT and ECT on someoperations as configuration modification and remote control with access filtering.
3 ) The NE which may be remotely controlled by a RECT must be configured and must be loadedwith the same SW version supporting the RECT function. A NE not supporting RECT functionshall refuse the incoming association issued by a RECT and the ECT displays only localinformation.
4 ) Only three RECTs shall be active at a time over one NE. The coexistence of ECTs and RECTsin the whole network is guaranteed since the conflict in configuring the NEs is solved locally bythe NE itself.
5 ) The operator, through the RECT function, is able to see the alarm synthesis of the wholenetwork .
6 ) In a network the maximum number of NEs equipped with the RECT function are 128. This valueidentifies what it is understood as ”small network” for which the RECT function may replace theElement Manager.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
258
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
259
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
APPENDIX C : GENERAL ON SWP INSTALLATION
This Appendix introduces the basic information regarding the software installation.
N.B. Before reading this paragraph, it is suggested to read (if not yet done) previous para.B.1 onpage 252.
Fig. 161. depicts the main phases for SW management.
SWPCD–ROM
CRAFT TERMINAL
1) SWP LOADING IN PCMS–NT ENVIRONMENT
2) NEW SWPINSTALLATION
3) NE SWP LOADINGINTO EQUIPMENTCONTROLLER(if necessary)
DURATION: – 1/2 hour with interface F– some minutes with Ethernet interface
5) NE CONFIG. DATA MNGT
4) AUTOMATIC SWDOWNLOAD TOSUPERVISOR UNITS(if necessary)
DURATION:some minutes
Fig. 161. Software management main phases
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
260
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
The SW management can be distinguished into:
– program management, i.e.:
• (1) and (2) : SWP loading from CD–ROM to the Personal Computer, after which the PCbecomes and can be used as the Equipment Craft Terminal
• (3) NE SWP downloading from ECT toward the Network–Element’s Equipment Controller (EC)
• (4) SW downloading from EC toward the Peripheral Units.
– NE configuration data management:
• (5) NE configuration data definition.
The installation can be distinguished in two main procedures:
– SWP installation in PC environmentthat includes tasks (1) and (2) mentioned above.The relevant operating instructions are given in chapter 1–1 on page 23
– SWP download toward NEthat includes tasks (3) to (5) mentioned above.The relevant operating instructions are given in chapter 1–2 on page 59
These main procedures are usually carried out sequentially; some different situations are described inpara.C.2 on page 261.
Furthermore, additional procedures are envisaged to be used in special situations, as described inpara.C.1 herebelow.
C.1 : Troubleshooting situations
In the following situations:
1 ) Flash Card to be replaced
or:
2 ) NE not in–factory configured
use the SW download through SIBDL program; refer to the dedicated section of the:
9400AWY Line Up Guide
or
9400FSO Line Up Guide
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
261
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
C.2 : Common situations
1 ) Network Element already configured with the more recent SWP version and CraftTerminal already available.
A.B.c
ECT
A.B.c
NE
ECT release = NE release
ECT version = NE version
This is the typical situation of new installations: the Network Element SW configuration matchesthe available Craft Terminal SWP version, so that the NE can be logged–in and the Operatorcan carry out the required operations, without any preliminary actions.
2 ) Network Element already configured with the more recent SWP version, but the CraftTerminal is not available or has a version older with respect to that of the NetworkElement(s).
A.B.c
ECT
A.B.d
NE
ECT release = NE release
ECT version < NE version
In this case, carry out SWP installation in Craft Terminal environment as explained in Chapter1–1 on page 23. After that, the situation is equal to that of point 1 ) above.
3 ) Both Network Element and Craft Terminal already configured with a SWP version olderthan that made available by the a new SWP version (SAME RELEASE)
A.B.c
ECT NE
=SWP
CD–ROMA.B.d
A.B.c running version < SWP version
running release = SWP release
This could be the typical situation of installations already running with A.B SWP package(e.g.1.0.0), in the case a newer version of the same A.B SWP package has to be installed(e.g.1.0.1).
Refer to Chapter 1–3 on page 75.After that, the situation is equal to that of point 1 ) above.
N.B. Please refer to para.E.2.5.2 on page 286 for the meaning of SWP Release, Version and PatchLevel.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
262
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
263
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
APPENDIX D : ECT–EQUIPMENT CONNECTION VIA PUBLIC SWITCHEDTELEPHONE NETWORK
D.1 : Introduction
This chapter explains the operations necessary to allow the remote connection to the F–Interface, froma local PC (with external or internal modem) configured as ECT, through a switched telephone line of thestandard Public Telephone Network, as shown in Fig. 162. here below.
This kind of remote control is possible for a single equipment as well as for a whole subnetwork.
��������������
� �� �
����� �������������� �����
������
�����
���
�����
F Interface
Port COM
� ��������� �� �� ������ �����
����� ������ � �����
Fig. 162. ECT–Equipment connection via Public Switched Telephone Network
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
264
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
D.2 : Certified equipment
The connection has been successfully tested:
a ) with the following types of modems:
1 ) Modem Sportster Flash (US Robotics)
2 ) Modem TD–32 AC (Westermo Teleindustri AB)
3 ) 3Com 56K Faxmodem
b ) with the following types of PC:
1 ) with external modem:characteristics as in para.4–2.1 on page 231
2 ) with internal modem:PC laptop Dell Latitude:– Processor equipped: PENTIUM III– Operating system: Microsoft Windows 2000 v. 5.00.2195 service pack 2– RAM equipped: 128 Mbytes– Hard disk equipped: 10 Gbytes– Internal Modem: 3COM 56K v.90 Mini PCI MODEM
c ) and with the following local/remote combinations:
Local Modem Remote Modem
Sportster Flash
Sportster Flash TD 32 AC
3Com 56K Faxmodem
TD 32 AC
TD 32 AC Sportster Flash
3Com 56K Faxmodem
TD 32 AC
PC laptop Dell Latitude as inpoint b ) 2 ) above
Sportster Flashpoint b ) 2 ) above
3Com 56K Faxmodem
Testing the connection with different types of modems is fully on Customer’s charge.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
265
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
D.3 : Connection cables
In the following figures, the cables for the connections are described:
PC/ECT (DTE)Cannon 9 pins female
Local Modem (DCE)Cannon 25 pins male
DCD
TDRD
DTRDSRRTSCTSGND
DCDTD
RDRTSCTSDSRDTRGND
1
346785
8
56207
2 3
4
2
Fig. 163. ECT–Local external Modem cable
Remote Modem (DCE)Cannon 25 pins male
F Interface (DCE)Cannon 9 pins male
TDRD
RTSCTSDSRCTSGND
TDRDRTSCTSDSRDTRGND
2 3456
207
32786
54
Fig. 164. F Interface–Remote Modem cable
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
266
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
D.4 : Modem setting
D.4.1 : Setting of Sportster Flash Modem & 3Com 56K Faxmodem
This modem requires only a SW setting via serial port.
There is a little difference between local and remote modems setting (refer to Fig. 162. on page 263 forthe distinction between “local” and “remote”), relevant to the auto–answer option that must be set in theremote modem and not set in the local modem.
LOCAL MODEM SETTING
To set the local modem, proceed as follows:
1 ) Only for external modem: connect the local modem to the PC/ECT with the cable of Fig. 163. onpage 265.
2 ) Only for external modem: Power and switch on the local modem.
3 ) On the PC, activate program HyperTerminal and configure the PC–Modem serial line with thefollowing parameters:
* Bits per second: 38400* Data Bits: 8* Parity: None* Stop Bit: 1* Flow control: None
4 ) Execute and store the modem set–up, writing the following commands in the HyperTerminalprogram window:
AT&F1<Return> (Best PC default configuration recall)ATT<Return> (Tone Dialling instead than Pulse Dialling)ATX3<Return> (Second Signal disabling, avoids problems with PABX)AT&W0<Return> (Configuration store in NVRAM 0)
5 ) Now, setting has been completed. External Modem can be switched off and disconnected, ifnecessary.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
267
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
N.B. For confirmation, the modem configuration can be checked writing the command“ATI4<Return>” in the HyperTerminal program window.Information displayed should be as follows:
ATI4U.S. Robotics Sportster Flash 56000 Settings... B0 E1 F1 L2 M1 Q0 V1 X3 Y0BAUD=38400 PARITY=N WORDLEN=8DIAL=TONE OFF LINE CID=0 &A3 &B1 &C1 &D2 &H1 &I0 &K1&M4 &N0 &P0 &R2 &S0 &T5 &U0 &Y1 S00=000 S01=000 S02=043 S03=013 S04=010 S05=008 S06=004S07=060 S08=002 S09=006 S10=014 S11=072 S12=050 S13=000S15=000 S16=000 S18=000 S19=000 S21=010 S22=017 S23=019S25=005 S27=001 S28=008 S29=020 S30=000 S31=128 S32=002S33=000 S34=000 S35=000 S36=014 S38=000 S39=012 S40=000S41=004 S42=000 LAST DIALED #:
REMOTE MODEM SETTING
To set the remote modem, proceed as follows:
a ) carry out same steps 1 ) , 2 ) , 3 ) as for local modem setting
b ) execute and store the modem set–up, writing in the HyperTerminal program window the samecommands described in step 4 ) for the local modem setting, and adding the following command:
ATS=1<Return> (Auto–answering setting)
c ) now, setting has been completed. Modem can be switched off and disconnected, if necessary.
N.B. For confirmation, the modem configuration can be checked writing the command“ATI4<Return>” in the HyperTerminal program window.Information displayed should be equal to that displayed for the local modem, with only thedifference for field S00:
S00=001 S01=000 S02=043 S03=013 S04=010 S05=008 S06=004
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
268
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
D.4.2 : TD–32 AC Modem setting
This modem requires an initial HW set–up via dip–switches and a SW setting via serial port.
To set the modem, both local and remote, proceed as follows:
1 ) The initial HW set–up via dip–switches is indicated in Fig. 165. herebelow:
ON
SW31 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
SW21 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
SW11 2 3 4
ON
SW51 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ON
SW41 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Fig. 165. TD–32 AC modem dip–switch setting
2 ) Connect the local modem to the PC/ECT with the cable of Fig. 163. on page 265.
3 ) Power on the local modem (there is no an ON/OFF switch).
4 ) On the PC, activate program HyperTerminal and configure the PC–Modem serial line with thefollowing parameters:
* Bits per second: 38400* Data Bits: 8* Parity: None* Stop Bit: 1* Flow control: None
5 ) Execute and store the modem set–up, writing the following commands in the HyperTerminalprogram window:
AT&F1<Return> (Best PC default configuration recall)AT&K0<Return> (DTE/DCE flow control disabling)ATA<Return> (Automatic Answer enabling ––> Only on Remote modem and
wait the message “NO CARRIER”)AT&W0<Return> (Configuration store in NVRAM 0)AT&Y0<Return> (Configuration Set to load at switch–on: NVRAM 0)
6 ) Now, setting has been completed. Modem can be switched off and disconnected, if necessary.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
269
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
N.B. For confirmation, the modem configuration can be checked writing the command“AT\S<Return>” in the HyperTerminal program window.Information displayed should be as follows:
AT\S CMD DESCRIPTION / OPTION CMD DESCRIPTION / OPTION CMD DESCRIPTION / OPTION––– –––––––––––––––––––– ––– –––––––––––––––––––– ––– –––––––––––––––––––– COUNTRY...........IT &A CHR ABORT OPT.....NO *H NEG. SPEED......HIGH DTE BPS........38400 &B DTR DIAL OPTION...NO S0 RINGS TO ANS.....002 DTE PARITY.....8NONE &C DCD OPTION........ON S1 RING COUNT.......000 LINE SPEED......NONE &D DTR OPTION.........0 S2 <ESC> CHAR.......043B BELL MODE........OFF &G GUARD TONE......NONE S3 <CR> CHAR........013E CMD ECHO..........ON &K FLOW CONTROL....NONE S4 <LF> CHAR........010F LINE MODE.......AUTO &L NETWORK.........PSTN S5 <BS> CHAR........008L SPKR VOLUME......LOW &Q ASYNC/SYNC.........5 S7 CONNECT TIME.....060M SPKR CONTROL....CALL &R RTS/CTS.........AUTO S8 PAUSE TIME.......002N AUTO MODE.........ON &S DSR OPT............0 S12 ESC GUARD TIME...050Q QUIET............OFF &T ENABLE RDL........NO S30 CONNECT INACT....000V RESULT FORM.....LONG &X SYNC CLOCK.......INT S32 XON CHAR.........017W EC MSG.............0 &Y PROFILE........NVM.0 S33 XOFF CHAR........019X EXT RESULTS........4 \A MAX BLK SIZE.....192 S36 FALLBACK ACTION..007Y LONG SPACE DISC...NO \G REMOTE FLOW......OFF S37 MODE SELECT......000%C COMPRESSION.....BOTH \K BRK OPT............5 S48 V42 NEG CTRL.....007–K EXT. SERVICES......0 \N ECL MODE........AUTO S95 RES. CODE........000
D.5 : PC laptop “Dell Latitude” setting
The following setting must be done:
Control Panel –> Alcatel Lower Layer –> Serial port –> COM3 and Serial port selected
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
270
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
D.6 : Setting up the connection
In order to activate the connection and operate the ECT in remote way, proceed as specified herebelow.Refer to Fig. 162. on page 263 for the distinction between “local” and “remote” modems.
N.B. Leaving the remote modem permanently switched on and permanently connected toF–interface and telephone line, operations set up by steps 1 ) thru 4 ) , it is possible to accessthe equipment in any moment.In order to access the equipment by local ECT, proceed as specified in steps 5 ) thru 14 ) .
1 ) Connect the remote modem to equipment’s F interface with the cable of Fig. 164. on page 265.
2 ) Connect the remote modem to the telephone line (as far as Sportster Flash model is concerned,the connector to be used is the nearest to that used for the connection with equipment’s Finterface and signed with the ’wall’ symbol).
3 ) Power and switch on the remote modem.
4 ) Be sure remote equipment is switched on and correctly working.
5 ) Connect the local modem to the PC/ECT (with the cable of Fig. 163. on page 265.) on the serialport assigned for the connection with F interface (usually COM1).
6 ) Connect the local modem to the telephone line (as far as Sportster Flash model is concerned,the connector to be used is the nearest to that used for the connection with equipment’s Finterface).
7 ) Power and switch on the local modem.
8 ) On the PC, activate program HyperTerminal and configure the PC–Local Modem serial line withthe following parameters:
* Bits per second: 38400* Data Bits: 8* Parity: None* Stop Bit: 1* Flow control: None
9 ) For PC laptop Dell Latitude only, type the following command inside HyperTerminal program:’AT&C0&D0&R1’
N.B. this command must be typed every time the Hyper terminal session is opened (thiscommand is not stored in the modem NV RAM).
10 ) Execute the telephone call from the PC writing the following command in the HyperTerminalprogram window:
ATDnnn<Return>
where “nnn” is the telephone network number associated to the remote telephone line (thatwhich the remote modem is connected to).
11 ) Wait the message indicating the successful connection between local and remote modems.
N.B. The message text depends on the modem type, as follows:
“CONNECT 14400/ARQ/V32/LAPM/V42BIS“ (Sportster Flash)“CONNECT 38400” (TD 32 AC)
12 ) Close HyperTerminal program.
13 ) Activate the ECT applicative SW as usual.
14 ) At the end of the job, after having logged out from the ECT applicative SW, close the connectionbetween local and remote modems, switching off the local modem or physically disconnectingthe cable connecting it to the PC.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
271
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
D.7 : Changing the ECT–equipment connection speed
D.7.1 : Introduction
This feature is meant to use modems with speed different from that documented in previous paragraphs,giving the possibility to configure the ECT connection through modem (speed values: 9600, 19200, 38400,56000) with automatic management of modem set–up and phone call at ECT start–up.
As a matter of fact, this feature is not enough to set up the desired configuration.
To make change operative, the following operations should be necessary:
– at equipment side, special pshell text commands must be forwarded through a special cable to beplugged inside the equipment
– at PC side, the configuration must be set–up as explained in the following para.D.7.2 on page 272.
The default speed is 38400 and must not be changed by Customer !
Customers who need the change of modem speed must require theoperation to be performed by the Technical Assistance Center (TAC) ofrelevant Alcatel Selling or Supporting Unit.
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO USE THIS FEATUREWITHOUT TAC ASSISTANCE.
YOU COULD CAUSEUNRECOVERABLE ECT UNACCESSIBILITY.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
272
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
D.7.2 : Configuration at PC side
N.B. Please read carefully paragraph Introduction on page 271.
To configure the modem with the relevant speed, enter the menu Settings –> Control Panel of theOperating System and open the Alcatel Lower Layers utility. The menu of Fig. 166. opens.
Fig. 166. Alcatel Lower Layers utility
In the Sub–network Type field select Modem.In the Modem field select the suitable Modem type.In the Modem speed field select the suitable speed (9600, 19200 or 38400) and click on OK.In the Phone Number field enter the phone number, which will be automatically called at the ECT start–up.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
273
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
APPENDIX E : DOCUMENTATION GUIDE
This appendix contains all information regarding:
– this handbook, herebelow
– the Customer Documentation set this handbook belongs to, on page 279
E.1 : Handbook guide
This paragraph contains all information regarding this handbook:
– Handbook applicability on page 274
– Purpose of the handbook on page 275
– Handbook history on page 276
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
274
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.1.1 : Handbook applicability
a ) Product-release applicabilityThis handbook applies to the following product-releases:
• 1+0 or 1+1 for Radio application 9400AWY
PRODUCT RELEASE ANV P/N FACTORY P/N
9411AWY 1.00.00 3DB 05476 AAAA 522.174.410
9413AWY 1.00.00 3DB 05478 AAAA 522.174.500
9415AWY 1.00.00 3DB 05481 AAAA 522.174.600
9418AWY 1.00.00 3DB 04729 AAAA 522.174.000
9423AWY 1.00.00 3DB 05484 AAAA 522.174.700
9425AWY 1.00.00 3DB 05490 AAAA 522.174.900
9428AWY 1.00.00 3DB 05493 AAAA 522.175.000
9432AWY 1.00.00 3DB 05496 AAAA 522.175.100
9438AWY 1.00.00 3DB 04732 AAAA 522.144.100
• 1+0 for Free Space Optics application 9400FSO
PRODUCT RELEASE ANV P/N FACTORY P/N
9400FSO 1.00.00 3DB 04263 AAAA 522.173.500
b ) NE applicabilityThis handbook applies to the following Network Elements (NE): ULS
c ) SWP Version applicabilityThis handbook applies to the following Software Package Releases (SWP) and SWP versions:
SWP ReleaseSWP ANV &
FACTORY P/NSWP Version
(N.B.1)
V.1.0.0 (N.B.2)
SWP 9400AWY R.1.0 CD–ROM ref.Tab. 16. on page 229 V.1.0.1 (N.B.3)p g
V.1.0.2
N.B.1 For the meaning of SWP Release and Version, please refer to para.E.2.5.2 on page 286.The indication of the Versions in this handbook has the following meaning:this handbook applies starting from the Versions stated in this table, but it could also apply tosubsequent Versions for the following reasons:
a ) the Operator Handbook is not modified, unless the new version distributed to theCustomers comprises changes to the man–machine interface, or even in the presence ofminor changes that do not affect negatively the understandability of the proceduresdescribed therein (e.g. a ”button” moved internally to a screen);
b ) furthermore, if the screens contained in the handbook show the ”version–release” of the”product–release”, then they are not replaced in the subsequent versions of handbook iftheir contents remains unchanged.
N.B.2: Version 1.0.0 manages the Radio application only (1+0 configuration).N.B.3: Versions from 1.0.1 manages the Radio application (1+0 and 1+1 configurations) and the
FSO application.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
275
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.1.2 : Purpose of the handbook
This handbook belongs to the Customer Documentation set envisaged for the equipment specified in para.E.1.1 on page 274.Please refer to para.E.2 on page 279 to have the list and description of such Customer Documentationset.
This handbook describes the operation and maintenance activities the operators can carry out accordingthe specific software application(s) referred to in this handbook (see para. E.1.1 on page 274).
This handbook must be used together with the associated Technical Handbook and, with someexceptions, does not replicate information contained into it.
In particular, all cautions relevant to safety on rules for EMC and ESD, as well as warnings regardingoperations that may cause damages to the equipment, are not duplicated here, but must be retrieved fromthe Technical Handbook.
When using this handbook, it is assumed that the Operators know:
• the structure (hardware composition) and all the possible operating modes of the equipment(product-release) that this handbook refers to.
• how to use a PC and the Windows environment applications.
Before accessing other sections of this handbook, read completely this section in order to have informationon:
– SWP P/Ns and composition
– how to access the other sections of this handbook according to the SWP type (if more than oneenvisaged)
– how to manage Craft Terminal SW and Equipment SW for new installations or for upgrading previousinstallation to the new SW version.
– how to make ECT–equipment remote connection on Public Switched Telephone Network.
The document that should be read before starting this document is:
– 9400 AWY Technical Handbook from Ed.03 for the Radio application.
– 9400 FSO Technical Handbook for the FSO application.
N.B. In any case, the Technical Handbook must be always available to the Operator in chargeof the equipment software management, as it contains information and documents that areused in the procedures described in this manual (e.g. the hardware setting documents, theunit replacement procedures (N.B.), etc.).
Reading the following manual:
– 1320CT Basic Operator’s Handbook V3.0.1
is not strictly necessary before starting this document, but its knowledge is necessary for operating theprocedures introduced by this document and detailed in the other sections of this Handbook.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
276
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.1.3 : Handbook history
The first and the two most recent editions of the document are indicated in the table of contents. Changeswith respect to the previous edition are pointed out by revision bars.
The following Tab. 24. indicates the handbook parts new and modified with respect to the previous edition.
Legendn = new part m = modified part blank= part unchanged
Tab. 24. Handbook historyHANDBOOK EDITION ⇒ 01 02 03 04 05
FRONT MATTER n
Preliminary information n
Handbook applicability, purpose and history n
Handbook structure n
Safety–EMC–ESD norms and equipment labelling n
Cautions to avoid equipment damage n m
Quick guide n m m
SECTION 1: INSTALLATION n m
1–1 SWP installation in PC environment n m m
1–2 SWP download toward NE n m m
1–3 NE Upgrade to a newer SWP ’version’ (same SWP ’release’) ÉÉÉÉ
n m
SECTION 2: AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT n
2–1 General introduction on views and menus n m m
2–2 Configuration n m
2–3 Equipment n m m
2–4 Line Interface n m
2–5 Radio n m
2–6 FSO n m m
2–7 External input and output points n m m
2–8 Supervision n
2–9 Protection schemes n m m
2–10 Loopbacks n m
2–11 Diagnosis n
2–12 Performance Monitoring n m
2–13 Software Download n m
SECTION 3: AWY/FSO NE MAINTENANCE n
3–1 Maintenance introduction n
3–2 Troubleshooting n
table continues
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
277
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Tab. 24. Handbook historyHANDBOOK EDITION ⇒ 0504030201
SECTION 4: SWP DESCRIPTION AND VERSIONS n m m
4–1 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 description n
4–2 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V.1.0.0 specific information n m m
4–3 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V.1.0.1 specific informationÉÉÉÉÉÉ n m
4–4 SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0 V.1.0.2 specific informationÉÉÉÉÉÉÉÉÉ
ÉÉÉÉÉÉÉÉÉ
n
SECTION 5: APPENDICES n
A Equipment description and components n m
B SW allocation, Flash Card and equipment control n m m
C General on SWP installation n m
DECT–Equipment connection via public switched telephonenetwork
n
E Documentation Guide n m m
F Acronyms and abbreviations n
G Glossary of terms n
E.1.3.1: Notes on on Ed.01
– Draft editions neither validated nor officially released issue, for internal validation purposes:• Ed.01A–DRAFT created on December 12th, 2003• Ed.01B–DRAFT created on January 26th, 2004• Ed.01C–DRAFT created on March 9th, 2004
– Ed.01 created on May 19th, 2004 is the first released and validated version of the handbook.
E.1.3.2: Notes on Ed.02
Ed.02 created on July 23rd, 2004 is the second released and validated version of the handbook.This issue has been done to align the handbook to the new features of SWP version V.1.0.1; for a summary,see new Chapter 4–3 SWP R.1.0 V.1.0.1 specific information in section SWP DESCRIPTION ANDVERSIONS.Changes related to this new version have been introduced throughout the handbook, where necessary.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
278
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.1.3.3: Notes on Ed.03
– Draft editions neither validated nor officially released issue, for internal validation purposes:• Ed.03A–DRAFT created on November 16th, 2004 (authors G.Ziliani & E.Corradini)• Ed.03B–DRAFT created on December 3rd, 2004 (author C.Nava)• Ed.03C–DRAFT created on December 21st, 2004 (authors G.Ziliani & E.Corradini)
– Ed.03 created on December 22nd, 2004 is the third released and validated version of the handbook.This issue has been done to align the handbook to the new features of SWP version V.1.0.2; for asummary, see new Chapter 4–4 SWP R.1.0 V.1.0.2 specific information in section SWPDESCRIPTION AND VERSIONS.Changes related to this new version have been introduced throughout the handbook, wherenecessary.Other main changes are:• Cautions to avoid equipment damage in front matter improved• in addition to changes for V1.0.2, section INSTALLATION has been fully revised and improved• in addition to changes for V1.0.2, section AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT has been fully revised
and improved.This edition can be used also with previous versions V1.0.0 & V1.0.1.Revision bars point out major (listed above) and minor (not listed above) modifications with respectto previous edition.Revision bars in correspondence of empty lines or empty table rows point out parts eliminated.Errors found in previous edition have been corrected.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
279
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.2 : Documentation set description
This paragraph contains all information regarding the Customer Documentation set this handbookbelongs to:
– 9400AWY Rel.1.0 product–release–version handbooks on page 280
– 9400FSO Rel.1.0 product–release–version handbooks on page 282
– Handbooks common to 9400AWY Rel.1.0 and 9400FSO Rel.1.0 on page 284
– Specific documentation for SNMP on page 285
– General on Alcatel Customer Documentation on page 285 including:
• Customer–Independent Standard Customer Documentation on page 285
• Product levels and associated Customer Documentation on page 286
• Handbook and CD–ROM supply to Customers on page 288
The list of handbooks given in the following is valid as at the issue date ofthis Handbook and can be changed without any obligation for ALCATELto update it in this Handbook.
Some of the handbooks listed in the following may not be available as atthe issue date of this Handbook.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
280
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.2.1 : 9400AWY Rel.1.0 product–release–version handbooks
This paragraph lists and briefly describes the handbooks making up the documentation set envisaged for9400AWY Rel.1.0 product release.
Please refer to following para.E.2.5 on page 285 for a general description of Alcatel CustomerDocumentation system.
The standard Customer Documentation in the English language for the 9400AWY Rel.1.0 system ismodularly composed by different handbooks.
Tab. 25. herebelow lists the handbooks.
The [REF] indication in Tab. 25. is relevant to the handbook brief description given in tables Tab. 26. thru’Tab. 28. and Tab. 33. thru’ Tab. 34. in the following.
Tab. 25. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 product release handbooks
TECHNICAL HANDBOOK REF
9400AWY Technical Handbook [A]
INSTALLATION AND LINE–UP HANDBOOKS
9400AWY Installation Handbook [B]
9400AWY Line–up Guide [C]
OPERATOR’S HANDBOOKS (in alternative, according to SWP used)
9400AWY/FSO CT Operator’s Handbook SWP 1.0 [I]
9400AWY/FSO CT Operator’s Handbook SWP 1.1 [J]
DOCUMENTATION CD–ROM
DCP 9400AWY R.1.0 CD_ROM [D]
1320 CT OPERATOR’S HANDBOOKS
– 1320CT Basic Operator’s Handbook– AS Operator’s Handbook– ELB Operator’s Handbooksee Tab. 34. on page 284
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
281
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Tab. 26. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Technical Handbook
REF HANDBOOKANV P/N
Factory P/NNOTES
[A]
9400 AWY Rel. 1.0 Technical Handbook3DB 05653 BAAA
without Factory P/Nfrom ED.03
[A]It provides information regarding AWY equipment description and composition, stationlayouts, hardware setting documentation and maintenance.
Tab. 27. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Installation and Line–Up Handbooks
• The Installation Handbook provides information regarding Equipment installation, accordingto Alcatel Installation Engineering Dept. rules.
• The Line–up Guide provides information regarding equipment line up and commissioning,according to Alcatel Installation Engineering Dept. rules.
REF HANDBOOKANV P/N
Factory P/NNOTES
[B] 9400 AWY Rel.1.0 Installation Handbook3DB 05653 DAAA
without Factory P/N
[C] 9400 AWY Rel.1.0 Line–up Guide3DB 05653 EAAA
without Factory P/N
Tab. 28. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Documentation on CD–ROM
REF CD–ROM TITLEANV P/N
Factory P/NNOTES
DCP 9400AWY 1.0 CD_ROM3DB 05653 AAAA
417.200.029
[D] Contains, in electronic format (ACROBAT pdf files), all handbooks listed in Tab. 25. onpage 280 (when all envisaged handbooks are released), with exception of 1320 CTOperator’s Handbooks
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
282
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.2.2 : 9400FSO Rel.1.0 product–release–version handbooks
This paragraph lists and briefly describes the handbooks making up the documentation set envisaged for9400FSO Rel.1.0 product release.
Please refer to following para.E.2.5 on page 285 for a general description of Alcatel CustomerDocumentation system.
The standard Customer Documentation in the English language for the 9400FSO Rel.1.0 system ismodularly composed by different handbooks.
Tab. 29. herebelow lists the handbooks.
The [REF] indication in Tab. 29. is relevant to the handbook brief description given in tables Tab. 30. thru’Tab. 34. in the following.
Tab. 29. 9400FSO Rel.1.0 product release handbooks
TECHNICAL HANDBOOK REF
9400FSO Technical Handbook [E]
INSTALLATION AND LINE–UP HANDBOOKS
9400FSO Installation Handbook [F]
9400FSO Line–up Guide [G]
OPERATOR’S HANDBOOKS (in alternative, according to SWP used)
9400AWY/FSO CT Operator’s Handbook SWP 1.0 [I]
9400AWY/FSO CT Operator’s Handbook SWP 1.1 [J]
DOCUMENTATION CD–ROM
DCP 9400FSO R.1.0 CD_ROM [H]
1320 CT OPERATOR’S HANDBOOKS
– 1320CT Basic Operator’s Handbook– AS Operator’s Handbook– ELB Operator’s Handbooksee Tab. 34. on page 284
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
283
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Tab. 30. 9400FSO Rel.1.0 Technical Handbook
REF HANDBOOKANV P/N
Factory P/NNOTES
[E]
9400FSO Rel.1.0 Technical Handbook3DB 05654 BAAA
without Factory P/N[E]
It provides information regarding FSO equipment description and composition, stationlayouts, hardware setting documentation and maintenance.
Tab. 31. 9400FSO Rel.1.0 Installation and Line–Up Handbooks
• The Installation Handbook provides information regarding Equipment installation, accordingto Alcatel Installation Engineering Dept. rules.
• The Line–up Guide provides information regarding equipment line up and commissioning,according to Alcatel Installation Engineering Dept. rules.
REF HANDBOOKANV P/N
Factory P/NNOTES
[F] 9400FSO Rel.1.0 Installation Handbook3DB 05654 CAAA
without Factory P/N
[G] 9400FSO Rel.1.0 Line–up Guide3DB 05654 DAAA
without Factory P/N
Tab. 32. 9400AWY Rel.1.0 Documentation on CD–ROM
REF CD–ROM TITLEANV P/N
Factory P/NNOTES
DCP 9400FSO 1.0 CD_ROM3DB 05654 AAAA
417.200.030
[H] Contains, in electronic format (ACROBAT pdf files), all handbooks listed in Tab. 29. onpage 282 (when all envisaged handbooks are released), with exception of 1320 CTOperator’s Handbooks
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
284
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.2.3 : Handbooks common to 9400AWY Rel.1.0 and 9400FSO Rel.1.0
Tab. 33. Operator’s Handbooks related to the specific Software Package SWP
REF HANDBOOKANV P/N
Factory P/NNOTES
[I]9400 AWY/FSO Rel.1.0CT Operator’s Handbook SWP 1.0
3DB 05653 CAAAwithout Factory P/N
nb1this handbook
[J]9400 AWY/FSO Rel.1.0CT Operator’s Handbook SWP 1.1
3DB 05653 FAAAwithout Factory P/N
nb2
Provides AWY/FSO SWP screens and operational procedures for Equipment SW management andmaintenance.
nb1 SWP identification: ref.Tab. 16. on page 229
nb2 SWP identification: t.b.d.
Tab. 34. Documentation common to Alcatel Network Elements using 1320CT platform
REFQ3CT–PVersion(N.B.)
HANDBOOKANV P/N
Factory P/NNOTES
[K]
� 3.0.11320CT Rel.3.xBasic Operator’s Handbook
3AL 79551 AAAA
957.140.042 N[K]
Provides general information and operational procedures common to all 1320CT (Craftterminal) of Alcatel InfoModel Network Elements.
[L]
� 3.0.1AS Rel.6.5Operator’s Handbook
3AL 88876 AAAAwithout Factory P/N
[L]Provides detailed information and operational procedures regarding the alarm Surveillancesoftware embedded in the 1320CT software package.
[M]
� 3.0.1ELB Rel.2.xOperator’s Handbook
3AL 88877 AAAAwithout Factory P/N
[M]Provides detailed information and operational procedures regarding the Event Log Browsersoftware embedded in the 1320CT software package.
[N]� 3.0.1
DCP 1320 CT 3.x CD_ROM EN
3AL 79552 AAAA417.100.032
[N]
Contains, in electronic format, the 1320 CT Operator’s Handbook REF.[K] to [N]
N.B. The CT Version is displayed when, on the PC, you select the 1320CT application for itslaunch. The Q3CT–P/K Version embedded in the SWP this handbook refers to, is specifiedin the paragraph ECT SW Sub–Components of chapter (in Section 4 – SWPDESCRIPTION AND VERSIONS) related to the SWP version you use.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
285
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.2.4 : Specific documentation for SNMP
The documents relevant to SNMP are not available as individual items, but are directly included in theSNMP SWP CD–ROMs themselves.
E.2.5 : General on Alcatel Customer Documentation
This paragraph describes in general the Alcatel Customer Documentation system, details the associationbetween the product levels and the associated documentation, and explains Customer Documentationcharacteristics as well as the policies for its delivery and updating.
E.2.5.1: Customer–Independent Standard Customer Documentation
a ) Definition
Standard Customer Documentation, referred to hereafter, must be always meant asplant–independent and is always independent of any Customization.
Plant–dependent and/or Customized documentation, if envisaged by the contract, is subjected tocommercial criteria as far as contents, formats and supply conditions are concerned
N.B. Plant–dependent and Customized documentation is not described here.
b ) Aims of standard Customer Documentation
Standard system, hardware and software documentation is meant to give the Customer personnelthe possibility and the information necessary for installing, commissioning, operating, andmaintaining the equipment according to Alcatel Laboratory design and Installation Dept. choices. Inparticular:
• the contents of the handbooks associated to the software applications focus on the explanationof the man–machine interface and of the operating procedures allowed by it;
• maintenance is described down to faulty PCB location and replacement.
N.B. No supply to Customers of design documentation (like PCB hardware design andproduction documents and files, software source programs, programming tools, etc.) isenvisaged.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
286
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.2.5.2: Product levels and associated Customer Documentation
See Fig. 168. on page 287.
a ) ProductsA ”product” is defined by the network hierarchical level where it can be inserted and by the wholeof performances and services that it is meant for.E.g. 9400AWY is a product.
b ) Product-releasesA ”product” evolves through successive ”product-releases”, which are the real products marketedfor their delivery at a certain ”product-release” availability date. A certain ”product-release” performsmore functionalities than the previous one.E.g. Rel.1.0 and Rel.2.0 are two successive ”product-releases” of the same ”product”.A ”product–release” comprehends a set of hardware components and at least one “SoftwarePackage” (SWP); as a whole, they identify the possible network applications and the equipmentperformances that the specific ”product-release” has been designed, engineered, and marketed for.
c ) Configurations and Network ElementsIn some cases, a ”product-release” includes different possible “configurations” which aredistinguished from one another by different “Network Element” (NE) types and, from themanagement point of view, by different SWPs.
d ) SWP Releases and Versions
See Fig. 167. herebelow.A SWP is identified by the “configuration” name and by the “version” number (tree digits).The version’s first digit corresponds to the “product–release” number first digit; the second digitidentifies, together with the first, the SWP “release”.The third digit of the SWP version identifies the Patch Level of the SWP Release.
SWP version
SWP Release
ProductRelease’sfirst digit
Patch Level
SWP evolution for bug fixing purposesor minor additional features
1. 0. 7or minor additional features(same SWP Release within sameProduct–Release)
1. 0. 9
SWP evolution for additional features(new SWP Release within same Product Release)
1. 0. 7(new SWP Release within same Product–Release)(N.B. see next page) 1. 1. 2
SWP evolution for additional features1. 0. 7
SWP evolution for additional features(new SWP Release of a new Product–Release) 2. 0. 2
Fig. 167. Example of SWP Release and Version numbering
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
287
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
N.B. Sometimes, different SWP Releases (within the same Product–Release) are commerciallydistinguished by different names, e.g. :
SWP version SWP–Release commercial name
1.0.x 1.0
1.1.x 1.0B
1.2.x 1.0C
e ) Customer Documentation
A ”product-release–(configuration)” has its own set of standard Customer Documentation, usuallyformed of several handbooks, i.e., in general:
• System and Hardware documentation:– one (or more) Technical Handbook(s)– an Installation Handbook– a Commissioning Handbook or Line–Up Guide
• Software documentation:– a Craft Terminal Operator’s Handbook, associated to the specific SWP–Release– other Operator’s Handbooks (typically those associated to the SW platform embedded
in the SWP)
PRODUCT
PRODUCT–RELEASE 1.0 PRODUCT–RELEASE 2.0evolution
CONFIG.A
ALTERNATIVE CONFIGURATIONS
CONFIG.B
SWP REL.1.0 SWP REL.1.1evolution
CONFIG.ASystem & HWDocumentation
SWP REL.1.0SW
Documentation
SWP REL.1.1SW
Documentation
PRODUCTLEVELS
DOCUMENTATION
Fig. 168. Example of Product levels and associated Customer Documentation
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
288
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
E.2.5.3: Handbook and CD–ROM supply to Customers
a ) Standard supply
Handbooks and CD–ROMs are standard commercial items and are ordered and delivered as anyother Alcatel commercial item.Handbooks and CD–ROMs are not automatically delivered together with the equipment they referto.The number of handbooks or CD–ROMs per type to be supplied must be decided at contract level.
b ) Product–documentation consistency
Equipment description and lay–out are always general, i.e. they never describe the actualcomposition of the equipment supplied to Customer (this task is entrusted to plant–dependentdocumentation).Detailed hardware documentation concerns actually supplied units and is coherent with theproduction issue of such units.Software–associated handbooks are coherent with the supplied SWP release.Copies of the handbooks regarding a specific product–release previously delivered can be requiredspecifying P/N and edition.
c ) In–advance supply
Whenever handbooks or CD–ROMs are delivered before the relevant equipment delivery, there isthe risk that their contents might not agree with the characteristics of the equipment which will bedelivered: the more they are in advance the less are they likely to agree.
d ) Supplying updated handbooks and CD–ROMs to Customers
Supplying updated handbooks or CD–ROMs to Customers who have already received previousissues is subject to commercial criteria.By updated handbook delivery, we mean the supply of a complete copy of a new issue of thehandbook (supplying errata–corrige sheets is not envisaged).
e ) Copyright notification
The technical information of the handbooks and CD–ROMs supplied to Customers is the propertyof ALCATEL and must not be copied, reproduced or disclosed to a third party without written consent.
f ) Supply to Customers of Customer Documentation source files
Presently not envisaged.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
289
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
APPENDIX F : ACRONYMS AND ABBREVIATIONS
N.B. For the explanation of the acronyms of the alarms refer to Section MAINTENANCEpara.3–2.4.1 Alarm synthesis indication on page 221.
ACD: Access Control Domain
ADM: Add/Drop Multiplexer
AIS: Alarm Indication Signal
ALR: Automatic Laser Restart
ALS: Automatic Laser Shutdown
ANSI: American National Standard Institute
APS: Automatic Protection Switching
AS: Alarm Surveillance
ASAP: Alarm Severity Assignment Profile
ATM: Asynchronous Transfer Mode
ATPC: Automatic Transmit Power Control
AVC: Attribute Value Change
BBE: Background Block Error
BER: Bit Error Rate
BIP: Bit Interleaved Parity
BKPV: Back Plane Version
CPI: Control Point Input
CPO: Control Point Output
CRC: Cyclic Redundancy Check
CSES: Consecutive Severely Errored Second
CD: Current Data
CD–ROM: Compact Disc Read Only Memory
CCITT: Telegraph and Telephone International Consultative Committee
CPU: Central Processor Unit
CT: Craft Terminal
DEM: DEModulator
DTE: Data Terminal Equipment
DTMF: Dual Tone Multi Frequency
EB: Errored Block
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
290
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
EC: Equipment Controller
ECC: Embedded Communication Channels
ECT: Equipment Craft Terminal
EFD: Event Forwarding Discriminator
ELB: Event Log Browsing
EML: Element Management Layer
EOW: Engineering Order Wire
EPS: Equipment Protection Switch
ES: Errored Second
ETSI: European Telecommunication Standard Institute
EW: Early Warning
FAD: Functional Access Domain
FD: Frequency Diversity
FEC: Forward Error Corrector
FSO: Free Space Optics
FTP: File Transfer Protocol
GA: General Alarm
GNE: Gateway Network Element
HCS: Higher order Connection Supervision
HBER: High Bit Error Rate
HD: History Data
HET: HETerofrequency
HMI: Human Machine Interface
HS: High Speed
HST: Hot STandby
ID: Identifier
IDU: InDoor Unit
ISO: International Standards Organization
IEEE: Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers
IM: Information Manager
IP: Input Port or Internet Protocol
ISO: International Standards Organization
Kbit/s: Kilobits per second
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
291
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
LAC: Local Access Control
LAN: Local Area Network
LBER: Low Bit Error Rate
LCS: Lower Order Connection Supervision
LO: Local Oscillator
LOF: Loss Of Frame
LOS: Loss Of Signal
LS: Low Speed
MAC: Media Access Control
Mbit/s: Megabits per seconds
MIB: Management Information Base
MLR: Manual Laser Restart
MOC: Managed Object Class
MOD: Modulator
MSp: Manual Switch to protecting channel
MSw: Manual Switch to working channel
NE: Network Element
NML: Network Management Layer
NMS: Network Management System
NSA: Non Service Affecting
NTP: Network Time Protocol
OBPS: On Board Power Supply
OC_F: ODU Controller_FSO
OC_R: ODU Controller_Radio
ODU: OutDoor Unit
OH: OverHead
OP: Output Port
OS: Operation System
OSI: Open Systems Interconnection
OSPF: Open Shortest Path First
PDH: Plesiochronous Digital Hierarchy
PI: Physical Interface
PLL: Phase Locked Loop
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
292
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
PM: Performance Monitoring
PPP:Point to Point Protocol
PSU: Power Supply Unit
QAM: Quadrature Amplitude Modulation
QOS: Quality Of Service
RAI: Remote Alarm Insertion
RAM: Random Access Memory
RC: Radio Controller
RDI: Remote Defect Indication
RECT: Remote Equipment Craft Terminal
REI: Remote Error Indication
RF: Radio Frequency
RPS: Radio Protection Switching
RS: Reed Solomon
RT: Transceiver
SA: Service Affecting
SC: Service Channel or System Controller
SD: Signal Degrade
SDH: Synchronous Digital Hierarchy
SES: Severly Errored Second
SF: Signal Fail
SSF: Server Signal Fail
SWP: SoftWare Package
TCP: Transmission Control Protocol
TDM: Time Division Multiplexer
TMN: Telecommunications Management Network
TN: Telecommunications Network
TP: Termination Point
UAS: UnAvailable Second
UAT: UnAvailable Time
URU: Underlying Resource UnAvailable
USM: User Service Manager
WST: Way Side Traffic
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
293
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
APPENDIX G : GLOSSARY OF TERMS
Acknowledgment:When an alarm is taken into account by the application, the operator has to acknowledge it to point outthat he has seen it and that he will react in the right way. During alarm configuration it is possible to seta maximum delay for alarm acknowledgement. The operator can decide whether or not the alarm clearhas to be acknowledged.
Administrator:A user who has access rights to all the Management Domains of the Craft Terminal product. He has accessto the whole network and to all the management functionalities.
Alarm:An alerting indication to a condition that may have an immediate or potentially negative impact on the stateof an equipment or the CT. An alarm is characterized by an alarm begin and an alarm end.
Alarm Profile:Function allowing the assignment of severities to the alarms depending on their probable causes.
Alarm Status:Identifies the type and severity of an occurring alarm.
Board:A board is part of an NE. They are electronic cards that fit into slots in the NE.
Compact Disk Read Only Memory:Data saving support from which the information can only be read. Is useful for stocking data due to itsavailable memory space.
Craft Terminal:Workstation or Personal computer (PC) from which local address to an NE is possible. It can be used toconfigure or perform monitoring tasks on the NE.
Digital Communication network:Communication Network in which the transmission of data is done in a digitized format.
Element Management Layer:This application is responsible for the configuration and management of Network Elements.
Equipment Protection Switching:Used to provide protection for cards within an equipment to protect traffic in the event of card failure.
Flushing:This deals with logs. When a log is flushed, all its records are deleted.
Functional Access Domain:It defines the range of functions which are available to a specified user.
Human Machine Interface:It is the graphical user interface application through which the operators interact with the system.
History Report:This function enables operators to get information concerning performances, security or alarms on entitiescomposing the network, or on the network itself. The operator specifies the time period for which herequires the report.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
294
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
International Telegraph and Telephone Consultative Committee:Standard organization for telecommunications. Now called the ITU–T (International TelecommunicationUnion).
Kilobits per second:Unit that correspond to the transmission of 103 bits every second.
Line Terminal:A line terminal is the end point of a communication link. it is used to transmit or receive signals. They canundertake signal conversion functions (adapting a signal to two different transmission media) ormultiplexing/demultiplexing functions.
Logs:Logs are files used to store history data concerning the incoming notifications, operator commands andsystem alarms. The size of the log can be configured.
Management Domain:The Craft Terminal product is partitioned into management domains for functional proposes. Eachmanagement domain is associated with functionalities that enable the operators to manage the NEs.
Megabits per second:Unit that corresponds to the transmission of 106 bits every second.
Network Access Domain:Defined as a set of Network Elements. NADs are used to define the set of Network Elements that a usercan manage.
Network Element:Either a telecommunication equipment or groups parts of a Telecommunication Network. Havecharacteristics compliant with CCITT recommendations.
Network Management Level:Designates the management functions performed on networks elements assembled in a network.
Notification:Spontaneous data received by the system concerning an NE.
Operation System:A system dedicated to the supervision of NEs in a standard way, using protocols and interfaces. it offers tothe operator a set of functions necessary to supervise the NEs. The 1353SH is an Operation System.
Operator:The end–user of the Craft Terminal. He supervises a part of the network that is dependant on his user profile.
Physical Interface:Electrical or Electrical/Optical transformers that decouple the line signals and adapt the form of signal forfurther transmission. This functional block also manages clock extraction, signal loss monitoring andloopback functions.
Port:A physical point at which the Network Element can be attached to a transmission medium. A port is eithera termination point or an origination point.
Severity:Linked to alarms, severities indicate the magnitude related to the failure.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
295
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
Telecommunication Management Network:Defines the concept of interoperable management of TNs. They provide an organized network structureto achieve the interconnection of the different components of the TN and the services to process theinformation.
Telecommunication Network:Describes the network to be managed. Provides the transmission, the transport and the switchingsupports to the interconnected Network Elements.
Terminal Point:Describes either the origin or the termination of a signal in an equipment. Is related to a port.
Thresholding:This is the assignment of a specified value to monitored parameters ( for example BIt Error Rates) that,when exceeded, generate trouble indications.
User Profile:Identifies the functionalities of the Craft Terminal to which a user has access. A finite number of predefineduser profiles is determined by a fixed set of FADs. To give user access to Craft Terminal functionality, theadministrator must assign a profile to a UNIX user account by choosing one among the predefined profilesinstalled with Craft Terminal.
User Service Manager:These are presentation processes used by the Craft Terminal to manage the Human Machine Interfaceand facilitate the interaction with the product.
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
296
03
/3DB 05653 CA AA
296
296
END OF DOCUMENT
3DB 05653 CAAA Ed.03
Craft Terminal Operator’s Handbook
Alcatel 9400AWY & 9400FSO
9400AWY Rel.1.011–13–15–18–23–25–28–32–38 GHz
Short–haul low/medium capacity digital microwave radio links
9400FSO Rel.1.0PDH Low/Medium Capacity Free Space Optic System
SWP 9400AWY R.1.0(from version V1.0.0)
3DB 05653 CAAA Ed.03
Documentation set for 9400AWY Rel.1.0
Handbook ANV P/N
9400AWY Technical Handbook 3DB 05653 BAAA
9400AWY Installation Handbook 3DB 05653 DAAA
9400AWY Line–up Guide 3DB 05653 EAAA
Documentation set for 9400FSO Rel.1.0
Handbook ANV P/N
9400FSO Technical Handbook 3DB 05654 BAAA
9400FSO Installation Handbook 3DB 05654 CAAA
9400FSO Line–up Guide 3DB 05654 DAAA
Handbooks common to 9400AWY Rel.1.0 and 9400FSO Rel.1.0
Handbook ANV P/N
9400 AWY/FSO CT Operator’s Handbook SWP 1.0 3DB 05653 CAAA this handbook
9400 AWY/FSO CT Operator’s Handbook SWP 1.1 3DB 05653 FAAA
1320CT Rel.3.x Basic Operator’s Handbook 3AL 79551 AAAA
AS Rel.6.5 Operator’s Handbook 3AL 88876 AAAA
ELB Rel.2.x Operator’s Handbook 3AL 88877 AAAA
When supplied on paper, this handbook is divided by registers, for an easier access to the informationherein contained:
CONTENTS REGISTER
FRONT MATTER:– TABLE OF CONTENTS– LIST OF FIGURES AND TABLES– PRELIMINARY INFORMATION– SAFETY–EMC–ESD NORMS AND EQUIPMENT LABELLING– CAUTIONS TO AVOID EQUIPMENT DAMAGE– QUICK GUIDE
SECTION 1: INSTALLATION 1
SECTION 2: AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT 2
SECTION 3: AWY/FSO MAINTENANCE 3
SECTION 4: SWP DESCRIPTION AND VERSIONS 4
SECTION 5: APPENDICES 5
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
Y 1
03
RELEASED
/3DB 05653 CAAA TQZZA
4
4
QUESTA PAGINA NON VA INSERITA NEL MANUALETHIS PAGE MUST NOT BE INCLUDED IN THE HANDBOOK
COD.MANUALE HDBK P/N: 3DB 05653 CAAA Ed.039400AWY & 9400FSO Rel.1.0SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0C.T. OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK
ORIGINALE INTERLEAF: FILE ARCHIVIAZIONE: cod ANV (PD1-PD2)
– No PAGINE TOTALI PER ARCHIVIAZIONE: 298+4 = 302– DIMENSIONE BINDER SORGENTE (du –ks): 443.620 Mbyte
INFORMAZIONI PER IL CENTRO STAMPA - ASSEMBLY INSTRUCTIONS
– STAMPARE FRONTE/RETRO RECTO-VERSO PRINTING– COMPOSIZIONE ED ASSIEMAGGIO DEL MANUALE:
HANDBOOK COMPOSITION AND ASSEMBLY:
SERVONO 5 SEPARATORI NUMERATI DA 1 A 55 REGISTERS NUMBERED FROM 1 TO 5 ARE NECESSARY
fasestep
No pagine(facciate)
numeratenumbered
step (facciate)No pages da from a to
i TARGHETTE - LABELS
ii FRONTESPIZIO - FRONT 2
iii FRONT MATTER ⇒ 1/296 20/296
iv INSERIRE SEPARATORE ’1’ - INSERT REGISTER ’1’
v SECTION 1: INSTALLATION ⇒ 21/296 76/296
vi INSERIRE SEPARATORE ’2’ - INSERT REGISTER ’2’
vii SECTION 2: AWY/FSO NE MANAGEMENT ⇒ 77/296 214/296
viii INSERIRE SEPARATORE ’3’ - INSERT REGISTER ’3’
ix SECTION 3: AWY/FSO MAINTENANCE ⇒ 215/296 226/296
x INSERIRE SEPARATORE ’4’ - INSERT REGISTER ’4’
xi SECTION 4: SWP DESCRIPTION AND VERSIONS ⇒ 227/296 240/296
xii INSERIRE SEPARATORE ’5’ - INSERT REGISTER ’5’
xiii SECTION 5: APPENDICES ⇒ 241/296 296/296
TOTALE PAGINE A4 (FACCIATE) TOTAL A4 PAGES: 298
TOTALE FOGLI A4 TOTAL A4 SHEETS: 149
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
Y 2
03
RELEASED
/3DB 05653 CAAA TQZZA
4
4
QUESTA PAGINA NON VA INSERITA NEL MANUALETHIS PAGE MUST NOT BE INCLUDED IN THE HANDBOOK
WTDSite
Originators
VIMERCATE
:
Domain
9400AWY REL.1.0
Division
9400FSO REL.1.0
Rubric
SWP 9400AWY R1.0 UP V102
TypeDistribution Codes Internal External
::::
9400AWY & 9400FSO Rel.1.0SWP 9400AWY R.1.0 9400AWY & 9400FSO C.T. OPERATOR’S HDBK
:
E.CORRADINIG.ZILIANIC.NAVA
Approvals
NameApp.
App.Name
A.FUMAGALLI
V.RODELLA A.BESTETTI
WARNING FOR A-UNITS OTHER THAN A-ITALY
• Labels are done according to A-Italy binder format.• Source files and printable files of this handbook are archived in ePDM:
– Source file: ALICE 6.10 ARCHIVED BY GAPI 3.9.1– Printable file: PDF file must be opened with ACROBAT Reader Version 5.0 at least.
3DB 05653 CAAAEd.039400AWY & 9400FSO Rel.1.0
SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0
11–38 GHz short–haul low/medium capacity digital microwave radio linksPDH Low/Medium Capacity Free Space Optic SystemC.T. OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
Y 3
03
RELEASED
/3DB 05653 CAAA TQZZA
4
4
9400AWY & 9400FSO Rel.1.0
SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0
11–38 GHz short–haul low/medium capacity digital microwave radio links
PDH Low/Medium Capacity Free Space Optic System
C.T. OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK
3DB 05653 CAAA Ed.03
VOL.1/1
9400AWY & 9400FSO Rel.1.0SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0
11–38 GHz short–haul low/medium capacity digital microwave radio linksPDH Low/Medium Capacity Free Space Optic System
C.T. OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK
3DB 05653 CAAA Ed.03
VOL.1/1
9400AWY & 9400FSO Rel.1.0SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0
11–38 GHz short–haul low/medium capacity digital microwave radio linksPDH Low/Medium Capacity Free Space Optic System
3DB 05653 CAAA Ed.03 C.T. OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK VOL.1/1
9400AWY & 9400FSO Rel.1.0SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0
11–38 GHz short–haul low/medium capacity digital microwave radio links PDH Low/Medium Capacity Free Space Optic System
3DB 05653 CAAA Ed.03 C.T. OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK VOL.1/1
9400AWY & 9400FSO Rel.1.0SWP REG.9400AWY R.1.0
11–38 GHz short–haul low/medium capacity digital microwave radio linksPDH Low/Medium Capacity Free Space Optic System
3DB 05653 CAAA Ed.03 C.T. OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK VOL.1/1
All
right
s re
serv
ed. P
assi
ng o
n an
d co
pyin
g of
this
docu
men
t, us
e an
d co
mm
unic
atio
n of
its
cont
ents
not p
erm
itted
with
out w
ritte
n au
thor
izat
ion
from
Alc
atel
.
ED
1AA
000
14 0
004
(900
7) A
4 –
ALI
CE
04.
10
Y 4
03
RELEASED
/3DB 05653 CAAA TQZZA
4
4
END OF DOCUMENT